WO2022199438A1 - 信息交互/处理方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法及装置 - Google Patents

信息交互/处理方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法及装置 Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2022199438A1
WO2022199438A1 PCT/CN2022/081127 CN2022081127W WO2022199438A1 WO 2022199438 A1 WO2022199438 A1 WO 2022199438A1 CN 2022081127 W CN2022081127 W CN 2022081127W WO 2022199438 A1 WO2022199438 A1 WO 2022199438A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
tag
information
label
user
page
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/CN2022/081127
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Inventor
潘昱昊
赵立悦
Original Assignee
北京字跳网络技术有限公司
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority claimed from CN202110322528.0A external-priority patent/CN115129404B/zh
Priority claimed from CN202110321003.5A external-priority patent/CN115130975A/zh
Priority claimed from CN202110322529.5A external-priority patent/CN115129405A/zh
Application filed by 北京字跳网络技术有限公司 filed Critical 北京字跳网络技术有限公司
Priority to US18/552,299 priority Critical patent/US20240195772A1/en
Publication of WO2022199438A1 publication Critical patent/WO2022199438A1/zh

Links

Images

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04LTRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04L51/00User-to-user messaging in packet-switching networks, transmitted according to store-and-forward or real-time protocols, e.g. e-mail
    • H04L51/07User-to-user messaging in packet-switching networks, transmitted according to store-and-forward or real-time protocols, e.g. e-mail characterised by the inclusion of specific contents
    • H04L51/08Annexed information, e.g. attachments
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F40/00Handling natural language data
    • G06F40/10Text processing
    • G06F40/166Editing, e.g. inserting or deleting
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F9/00Arrangements for program control, e.g. control units
    • G06F9/06Arrangements for program control, e.g. control units using stored programs, i.e. using an internal store of processing equipment to receive or retain programs
    • G06F9/44Arrangements for executing specific programs
    • G06F9/451Execution arrangements for user interfaces
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04LTRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04L51/00User-to-user messaging in packet-switching networks, transmitted according to store-and-forward or real-time protocols, e.g. e-mail
    • H04L51/04Real-time or near real-time messaging, e.g. instant messaging [IM]
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04LTRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04L51/00User-to-user messaging in packet-switching networks, transmitted according to store-and-forward or real-time protocols, e.g. e-mail
    • H04L51/21Monitoring or handling of messages
    • H04L51/216Handling conversation history, e.g. grouping of messages in sessions or threads

Definitions

  • the present application relates to the field of computers, and in particular, to an information interaction method, a label deletion method, an information processing method, a schedule-based information processing method, and a method and apparatus for creating a schedule.
  • tags can add tags to specific objects, for example, can add tags to objects such as cloud documents, schedules, instant messaging (Instant Messaging, IM) groups, and instant messaging messages. In this way, the user can find the target object relatively quickly through the tag.
  • IM Instant Messaging
  • the embodiments of the present application provide an information interaction method, a label deletion method, a schedule creation method, and a schedule-based information processing method and apparatus.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a method for information interaction, the method comprising:
  • the first correspondence is the correspondence between the target label and the first object
  • a second correspondence is generated, where the second correspondence is a correspondence between the target label and a second object, and the second object is related to the first object linked object.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a method for deleting a label, the method comprising:
  • deleting a second correspondence In response to deleting the first correspondence, deleting a second correspondence, the second correspondence being the correspondence between the target label and a second object, the second object being related to the first object linked object.
  • an apparatus for information interaction including:
  • a receiving module configured to receive a tag adding operation triggered by a user on the first object
  • a first generation module configured to generate a first correspondence according to the label adding operation, where the first correspondence is a correspondence between a target label and the first object;
  • a second generation module configured to generate a second correspondence in response to generating the first correspondence, where the second correspondence is the correspondence between the target label and a second object, and the second object is an object associated with the first object.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a label deletion device, including:
  • a receiving module configured to receive a label deletion operation triggered by a user on the first object
  • a first deletion module configured to delete a first correspondence according to the label deletion operation, where the first correspondence is a correspondence between a target label and the first object;
  • a second deletion module configured to delete a second correspondence in response to deleting the first correspondence, where the second correspondence is the correspondence between the target label and a second object, and the second object is an object associated with the first object.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a task-based information processing method, the method comprising:
  • the tag is an additional attribute of the at least one task, and the tag is shared within a preset range determined by the authority of the tag;
  • Information corresponding to each task in the at least one task is displayed on a first page, where the first page is a page displayed on a client that logs in to the account of the first user.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides an information processing method, the method comprising:
  • a first information addition page is displayed, where the first information addition page includes identifiers of multiple information fields, and the multiple information fields include the first information domain and a second information domain;
  • an association relationship between the at least one piece of information and the first tag is generated.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a task-based information processing device, the device comprising:
  • a first acquiring unit configured to acquire at least one task related to the first user and having a tag, the tag is an additional attribute of the at least one task, and the tag is in a preset determined by the authority of the tag share within the scope;
  • a first display unit configured to display information corresponding to each task in the at least one task on a first page, where the first page is a page displayed on a client that logs in to the account of the first user.
  • an information processing device comprising:
  • a first display unit configured to display a first information addition page in response to an information addition operation triggered by a user for the first information field, where the first information addition page includes identifiers of a plurality of information fields, the plurality of information the domain includes the first information domain and the second information domain;
  • a second display unit configured to display candidate information corresponding to a second information field in response to a selection operation triggered by the user for the identifier of the second information field, where the second information field is different from the first information field ;
  • a first generating unit configured to generate an association relationship between the at least one piece of information and the first tag in response to a selection operation triggered by the user for at least one piece of information in the candidate information.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a method for creating a schedule, the method comprising:
  • a schedule adding page is displayed, the schedule adding page includes the first label, and the associated page of the first label is used to present the first label.
  • the associated information of a tag
  • the schedule information input by the user in the schedule adding page is acquired, and a schedule with the first label is generated.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a method for creating a schedule, the method comprising:
  • a schedule adding page is displayed, the schedule adding page includes the first label, and the associated page of the first label is used to present the first label.
  • the associated information of a tag
  • the schedule information input by the user on the schedule adding page is acquired, and a schedule with the second label is generated.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides an apparatus for creating a schedule, the apparatus comprising:
  • a display unit configured to display a schedule adding page in response to a schedule adding operation triggered by a user on the associated page of the first label, where the schedule adding page includes the first label, and the associated page of the first label is displayed with for presenting the associated information of the first tag;
  • a first acquiring unit configured to acquire schedule information input by the user in the schedule adding page
  • a generating unit configured to generate a schedule with the first tag.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a schedule creation apparatus, the apparatus includes:
  • a first display unit configured to display a schedule adding page in response to a schedule adding operation triggered by a user in the associated page of the first label, where the schedule adding page includes the first label and the associated page of the first label , used to present the associated information of the first tag;
  • a modification unit configured to modify the first tag to a second tag in response to a tag editing operation triggered by the user in the schedule adding page
  • an obtaining unit configured to obtain the schedule information input by the user in the schedule adding page
  • a generating unit configured to generate a schedule with the second tag.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a device, the device includes a processor and a memory;
  • the processor is configured to execute the instructions stored in the memory, so that the device performs any one of the above first aspect or any one of the above second aspect or any one of the fifth aspect or any one of the sixth aspect or The method of any one of the ninth aspect or any one of the tenth aspect.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a computer-readable storage medium, including instructions, the instructions instructing a device to execute any one of the above first aspect or any one of the above second aspect or any one of the fifth aspect Or the method described in any one of the sixth aspect or any one of the ninth aspect or any one of the tenth aspect.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a computer program product, which, when the computer program product runs on a computer, causes the computer to execute any one of the above first aspects or any one of the above second aspects or the fifth The method of any one of the aspects or any one of the sixth aspect or any one of the ninth aspect or any one of the tenth aspect.
  • the first correspondence may be generated according to the tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object, and the second correspondence may be automatically generated in response to the generation of the first correspondence. That is, a first object can be tagged, and a second object can be automatically tagged based on the "tag first object" behavior.
  • the same tag can be automatically added to other objects associated with the object, without adding a tagging operation for each object separately.
  • the user wants to add tags to multiple related objects he only needs to trigger the tagging operation on one of the objects. In this way, the number of tag adding operations that need to be triggered by the user is reduced, the speed of tag adding is increased, and the user can get a better experience.
  • the client may obtain at least one task that is related to the first user and has a tag.
  • the tag is an additional attribute of the at least one task, and the tag can be shared within a preset range determined by the permissions of the tag.
  • information corresponding to each task in the at least one task may be presented on the first page displayed by the client. It can be seen that, with this solution, the first user can view the information of at least one task related to himself on the first page without opening the pages corresponding to each tag, the user's operation is simple, and the user's view of the information related to himself is improved. task efficiency.
  • the embodiments of the present application provide an information processing method.
  • the user may trigger an information addition operation for the first information domain.
  • the client may respond to the operation and display the first information adding page.
  • the first information addition page includes identifiers of multiple information domains, and the multiple information domains include the first information domain and the second information domain.
  • the user may select an operation triggered by the identifier of the second information domain, and the client terminal may display candidate information corresponding to the second information domain in response to the user's selection operation triggered by the identifier of the second information domain.
  • the second information field mentioned here is different from the first information field.
  • the user may trigger a selection operation for at least one piece of candidate information
  • the client may generate the at least one piece of information in response to a selection operation triggered by the user for at least one piece of the candidate information.
  • the embodiment of the present application provides a method for creating a schedule.
  • the user can trigger a schedule adding operation on the associated page of the first label displayed on the client side, and the client terminal can display the schedule adding page in response to the schedule adding operation, and the schedule adding page includes the first label.
  • the associated page of the first tag is used to present the associated information of the first tag.
  • the user can input schedule information on the schedule adding page, and the client can obtain the schedule information, and further generate a schedule with the first tag based on the schedule information. It can be seen that with this solution, after the user triggers the schedule adding operation on the associated page of the first label, the first label is automatically brought into the schedule adding page, and further, a schedule including the first label can be generated. There is no need for the user to first create an event and then add a tag to the event, thereby reducing the tedious operation of creating a tagged event.
  • the embodiment of the present application provides a method for creating a schedule.
  • the user can trigger a schedule adding operation on the associated page of the first label displayed on the client side, and the client terminal can display the schedule adding page in response to the schedule adding operation, and the schedule adding page includes the first label.
  • the associated page of the first tag is used to present the associated information of the first tag.
  • the user can trigger a label editing operation on the schedule adding page to modify the first label on the schedule adding page to the second label.
  • the user can input schedule information on the schedule adding page, and the client can obtain the schedule information, and further generate a schedule with the second tag based on the schedule information.
  • FIG. 1 is a schematic flowchart of a method for information interaction provided by the present application
  • FIG. 2 is a schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application
  • FIG. 3 is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 4 is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 5 is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 6-a is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 6-b is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 6-c is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 6-d is another schematic diagram of a display interface of a client according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 7 is a schematic flowchart of a method for deleting a label provided by the application.
  • FIG. 9 is a schematic structural diagram of an apparatus for information interaction provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic structural diagram of a label deletion device provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 11 is a schematic structural diagram of an electronic device provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 12 is a schematic flowchart of a task-based information processing method provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 13 is a schematic diagram of a first page provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • 15a is a schematic diagram of an overview page of a first tag provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • 15b is a schematic diagram of an information addition page provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 15c is a schematic diagram of another information addition page provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • 16 is a schematic structural diagram of a task-based information processing apparatus provided by an embodiment of the application.
  • FIG. 17 is a schematic structural diagram of an information processing apparatus provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 19 is a schematic diagram of a schedule adding page provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • 20 is a schematic flowchart of another method for creating a schedule provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • 21 is a schematic structural diagram of a schedule creation apparatus provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 22 is a schematic structural diagram of another apparatus for creating a schedule according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • the term “including” and variations thereof are open-ended inclusions, ie, "including but not limited to”.
  • the term “based on” is “based at least in part on.”
  • the term “one embodiment” means “at least one embodiment”; the term “another embodiment” means “at least one additional embodiment”; the term “some embodiments” means “at least some embodiments”. Relevant definitions of other terms will be given in the description below.
  • tags At present, in order to facilitate management and search, some software has the function of adding tags. Users can add tags to objects such as messages and cloud documents by adding tags. This way, users can find objects such as messages or cloud documents by tags.
  • the user can trigger the label adding operation on the target object to be labeled, for example, the label adding operation can be triggered by clicking the label adding control corresponding to the target object.
  • the client After receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user, the client can determine the target tag according to the tag adding operation, and generate the corresponding relationship between the target object and the target tag, so as to add the target tag to the target object. In this way, a tag can be added to the target object based on the tag adding operation, so that the user can flexibly manage the target object.
  • the existing tagging method needs to trigger the tagging operation once for each target object. When there are a large number of target objects to be tagged, the user needs to trigger a tag adding operation for each target object respectively. Obviously, this greatly increases the amount of user operations, and not only reduces the speed of adding labels.
  • the user can only trigger the label deletion operation for one target object at a time.
  • the user needs to trigger a tag deletion operation for each target object in the multiple target objects.
  • the user can also delete the target tag directly, this will delete the target tag of all the target objects with the target tag, and cannot delete the target tag of some target objects with the target tag.
  • FIG. 1 is a schematic flowchart of a method for information interaction provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • This embodiment is applicable to a scenario where tags are added to associated first objects and second objects, and the method can be performed by a processing device for adding tags.
  • the apparatus may be implemented by software and/or hardware, and integrated into the user's client.
  • the client can be integrated in a PC (Personal Computer, personal computer) end or a mobile terminal.
  • the information interaction method (including the tag deletion method described later) provided by the embodiments of the present application may also be executed by a computer device such as a server.
  • the following takes the method executed by the client as an example for description. As shown in Figure 1, the method specifically includes the following steps:
  • S101 Receive a tag adding operation triggered by a user on the first object.
  • the first object may be any one of objects such as cloud files, local files, folders, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages, and instant messaging groups, that is, the user can trigger tags on the above objects Add action.
  • the second object described below may be any object associated with the first object among objects such as cloud files, local files, folders, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages, and instant messaging groups.
  • the cloud file may be a file stored on a server, for example, a cloud document, that is, a document file stored on the server, or a cloud video, that is, a video file stored on the server.
  • the user can download the cloud file from the server to the local, or can also open (for example, open in a web browser) the cloud file by accessing the storage address of the cloud file stored in the server.
  • Local files are files stored locally on the client.
  • a folder can be a folder of cloud files or a folder of local files.
  • Instant messaging messages are messages sent or received by users through instant messaging software.
  • IM messages include group chat IM messages and single chat IM messages.
  • the group chat IM message is a message sent by an IM user in an IM group
  • the single-chat IM message is a message sent by an IM user to another IM user through a single chat.
  • the instant messaging group includes at least three instant messaging users, and messages sent in the instant messaging group can be seen by any instant messaging user in the group.
  • a single chat is a message sent between two IM users, which cannot be seen by a third IM user.
  • the label adding operation may be a sliding operation, or may be an operation triggered by adding a label to a control, for example, an operation such as clicking a label to add a control.
  • the sliding operation refers to the sliding track on the screen that is acquired by the client and triggered by the user.
  • the sliding operation may be an operation in which the user controls the cursor or the mouse to move on the screen through a peripheral device (for example, a mouse, a tablet, etc.) to generate a sliding track;
  • the screen of the client is a touch screen, the sliding operation It can be an operation in which the user moves a finger on the screen to generate a sliding track.
  • the sliding track is the preset track
  • the client can record the sliding track of the user's finger. If it is detected that the sliding track is circular, it can be determined that the user has triggered the tag adding operation.
  • the label adding control is the control used to trigger the label adding operation.
  • the client can determine that the user triggers the label adding operation.
  • the user can trigger a tag adding operation on the first object on the interface displaying the first object, or can trigger a tag adding operation on the first object on the tag display interface displaying the tag.
  • the first corresponding relationship After receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object, the first corresponding relationship may be generated according to the tag adding operation.
  • the first correspondence is the correspondence between the first object and the target label.
  • the target label is a label that the user wants to add to the first object.
  • the first object may be any one of operation objects that can be tagged, such as folders, cloud files, local files, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages, and instant messaging groups.
  • the second object described later may be any one of the above objects that is associated with the first object.
  • the target label may be determined according to the label adding operation.
  • the target tag may be created by the user who triggers the tag adding operation, or may be created by another user different from the user.
  • the target tag multiple candidate tags that can be added can be presented. Then, after triggering the tag adding operation, the user can select the target tag to be added, that is, select one or more tags from the candidate tags as the target tag.
  • the user-triggered selection operation may be received after receiving the user-triggered tag adding operation, so as to determine the target tag according to the user's requirements, so as to add the target tag to the first object.
  • the displayed at least one candidate tag may be arranged according to a preset rule.
  • the preset rule may include any one or more of tag creation time, tag access time, and matching degree with keywords.
  • the candidate tags may include tags created by the user or tags created by other users, and the keywords may be keywords entered by the user in the tag search box.
  • a corresponding relationship between the first object and the target label may be generated, and the target label is added to the first object.
  • the first correspondence may further include a correspondence between the target tag and an information block (Block) of the first object.
  • the second correspondence may also include the correspondence between the target tag and the information block of the second object.
  • the information block is generated based on an object (eg, a first object or a second object).
  • the information block of the first object may include summary information of the first object, used to briefly describe the first object;
  • the information block of the second object may include summary information of the second object, used to briefly describe the second object .
  • the information block of the second object may include abstract information of the cloud document, and the abstract information of the cloud document may include information such as the title, author, and release time of the cloud document;
  • the summary information of the second object may be the sender of the instant messaging message and the first n words of the instant messaging message, where n is an integer greater than or equal to 1.
  • the information block may also include presentation information of an object (eg, a first object or a second object) for presenting the object.
  • presentation information of an object eg, a first object or a second object
  • the display information of the first object may include a link to the cloud document, through which the entire content of the cloud document may be displayed;
  • the first object is an instant messaging message, the first object's
  • the display information can include the entire content of the instant messaging message corresponding to the target tag (without opening the instant messaging software window), or include the call chain of the instant messaging message, through which the call chain can be displayed in the instant messaging software window corresponding to the target label.
  • the full content of the technical newsletter is not limited to the technical newsletter.
  • the second correspondence described later may also include the correspondence between the target tag and the information block of the second object.
  • the second correspondence may be generated according to the generation of the first correspondence or the aforementioned tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object.
  • the second correspondence is the correspondence between the second object and the target label.
  • the second object is an object associated with the first object. That is, after receiving the tag adding operation for adding the target tag to the first object, the target tag can be automatically added to the second object associated with the first object according to the tag adding operation.
  • the second object is first introduced in detail below.
  • the second object is an object associated with the first object, such as other objects belonging to the first object, or other objects generated on the basis of the first object.
  • the first object is a folder
  • the second object may be a subfolder or a file in the folder. That is, the second object is another object belonging to the first object.
  • the first object is an instant messaging group
  • the second object may be a message sent by the user in the instant messaging group (for example, a message in the instant messaging group that is followed by group members in a certain way) or a file. That is, the second object is other objects generated on the basis of the first object.
  • the second object may be a historical association object acquired by the client or server before receiving the tag adding operation, or may be a new object acquired by the client or server after receiving the tag adding operation.
  • the two cases are described below.
  • the second object is a historical association object acquired by the client or the server before receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object, that is, the client or the server first acquires the second object, and then Receives tag addition operations. Then, after acquiring the second object, the association relationship between the first object and the second object can be recorded. After receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object, the stored association relationship can be searched to determine the second object associated with the first object, and then generate the second correspondence between the second object and the target tag relationship to add a label to the second object.
  • the first object is an instant messaging group A
  • the second object is a group chat instant messaging message B as an example for description.
  • the client After receiving the group chat IM message B through the IM group A, the client can record the association relationship between the group chat IM message B and the IM group A. Then, after receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user to the IM group A, the client can search for the group chat IM message B associated with the IM group A according to the recorded association relationship, and generate the target tag and group Chatting about the correspondence between the instant messaging messages B, adding a target tag to the group chat instant messaging message B, without the need for the user to manually add the target tag to the group chat instant messaging message B.
  • the second object is a new associated object acquired by the client or server after receiving the tag adding operation, that is, the client or server first receives the tag adding operation, and then acquires the second object. Then, after receiving the label adding operation, the label adding operation can be recorded, and after obtaining the second object, the corresponding relationship between the second object and the target label is generated according to the recorded label adding operation, and the label is added to the second object. .
  • the first object is the instant messaging group A
  • the second object is the group chat instant messaging message B as an example for description.
  • the client After receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user to the instant messaging group A, the client can record the tag adding operation. Then, if a new group chat IM message B is received through the IM group A, the client can determine that the group chat IM message B is associated with the IM group A, and thus generate a new group chat message B according to the recorded tag adding operation.
  • the second correspondence between the group chat instant messaging message B and the target label is to add a target label to the group chat instant messaging message B.
  • the client or the server may first determine that the user has triggered to enable the automatic label adding function.
  • the fact that the automatic tag adding function is enabled means that the user allows the client or the server to add tags to the second object according to the operation of adding tags to the first object. That is, when the automatic label adding function is enabled, the first correspondence can be generated according to the label adding operation, and the target label can be automatically added to the second object based on the generation of the first correspondence.
  • the automatic label adding function is disabled, the first corresponding relationship may be generated only according to the label adding operation, and the second corresponding relationship may not be generated based on the first corresponding relationship.
  • the user can enable or disable the automatic adding function of the operation control label triggered by the operation control.
  • the client can present a first control to the user, where the first control is used to control the opening or closing of the automatic label adding function. If it is detected that the user triggers the first control, the function of automatically adding tags can be enabled (or disabled).
  • the target tag may be created by the user who triggers the tag adding operation, or may be created by a user other than the user. Then, before generating the second correspondence, it may also be determined whether the user who triggers the tag adding operation has the tag adding authority of the second object. If the user has the label adding authority of the second object, the second correspondence can be generated. If the user does not have the permission to add tags to the second object, even if the first object and the second object are associated objects and the first object has been tagged, the target tag will not be automatically added to the second object.
  • the client before generating the second correspondence, it may be determined whether the user set indicated by the first object has the ability to add tags to the second object. For example, the client can determine whether the user set indicated by the first object has the access right of the second object. If the user set indicated by the first object does not have access rights to the second object, it means that the user set corresponding to the first object may not be able to view or edit the second object, and the client may not generate the second correspondence. Conversely, if the set of users indicated by the first object has the access rights of the second user. The client may generate the second correspondence. It should be noted that the set of users indicated by the first object is a whole. That is, even if one or more users in the set of users indicated by the first object have access rights to the second object, the set of users indicated by the first object may still not have access rights to the second object.
  • the first object is an instant messaging group
  • the second object is a cloud file sent to the instant messaging group. Then, after adding the target label to the instant messaging group, and before adding the target label to the cloud file, it can be determined whether the user set corresponding to the instant messaging group has the access right to the cloud file. If the user set corresponding to the instant messaging group has access rights to the cloud file, a corresponding relationship between the cloud file and the target tag can be generated, and the target tag can be added to the cloud file.
  • the first correspondence and the second correspondence are automatically generated by the client or the server according to the tag addition operation triggered on the first object, that is, the target tag of the first object is manually added by the user, and the second The object's target tag is added automatically.
  • the tag type of the target tag in the second correspondence can be set to the automatic addition type, indicating that the target tag of the second object is automatically added, not according to the second Added by the object's label add operation.
  • the specific function of the label type reference may be made to the introduction of the embodiment shown in FIG. 7 later, which will not be repeated here.
  • the second corresponding relationship After the second corresponding relationship is generated, if a label adding operation for adding a target label to the second object is received, since the corresponding relationship between the second object and the target label has already been generated, a new corresponding relationship may not be generated, and the The tag type of the target tag in the second corresponding relationship is modified to be a manually added type.
  • the client may display prompt information, where the prompt information is used to indicate completion of adding target tags to the first object and the second object.
  • the prompt message may be an icon or a notification message.
  • the client can correspondingly release the second correspondence.
  • the client can correspondingly release the second correspondence.
  • the first correspondence may be generated according to the tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object, and the second correspondence may be automatically generated in response to the generation of the first correspondence. That is, a first object can be tagged, and a second object can be automatically tagged based on the "tag first object" behavior.
  • the same tag can be automatically added to other objects associated with the object, without adding a tagging operation for each object separately.
  • the user wants to add tags to multiple related objects he only needs to trigger the tagging operation on one of the objects. In this way, the number of tag adding operations that need to be triggered by the user is reduced, the speed of tag adding is increased, and the user can get a better experience.
  • the first object and the second object may be objects in a project collaboratively processed by multiple users.
  • the client or server can generate the corresponding relationship between the instant messaging group Y and the target tag M, And the target tag M is automatically added to the cloud file Z based on the generation of the corresponding relationship.
  • other users in the instant messaging group Y can see that the instant messaging group Y has the target label M, and can also see that the cloud file has the target label M.
  • tags can be automatically added to one or more other related objects in the project based on a user-triggered tagging operation on one object.
  • first object and the second object may be any one of folders, cloud files, local files, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages and instant messaging groups. That is, a user can add the same label to objects in different label domains, and can view objects belonging to different label domains of the label. In this way, the cross-tag domain assignment of tags is realized, and the flexibility of management is improved.
  • tags may be any one of folders, cloud files, local files, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages and instant messaging groups.
  • first correspondence and/or the second correspondence in the embodiment of the present application may further include the correspondence between labels and information blocks.
  • information such as the abstract information of the object can also be displayed to the user according to the tag and the information block of the object. In this way, the amount of information that the user can see is increased, so that the user can find the desired object faster.
  • different objects belonging to different tag domains may be extracted as information blocks, and a corresponding relationship between the information blocks and the tags is generated.
  • extracting objects of different label domains into information blocks can solve heterogeneous information entities, homogenized modeling and labeling consistency in the circulation of cross-business applications and cross-business domains, and support cross-business information aggregation and secondary consumption scene.
  • the information block is to uniformly encapsulate the objects from different label domains (ie heterogeneous information entities), so that during the marking operation, there is no need to care about the different structures of the content of different domains, and the marking system can be unified. Action is required. If no encapsulation is done, heterogeneous entities in different domains will require relatively high integration costs if there is no homogeneous solution.
  • the user may operate the label of the second object. For example, the user may trigger a tag deletion operation on the second object, so as to control the client or the server to delete the second correspondence.
  • the user can also trigger a tag editing operation on the second object.
  • the target object in the second corresponding relationship may be modified according to the label editing operation.
  • the user can also trigger a tag adding operation on the second object.
  • a new target label may be determined according to a label adding operation triggered by the user on the second object, and a third corresponding relationship may be generated, where the third corresponding relationship is a corresponding relationship between the new target label and the second object.
  • the above process is described below by taking the example that the first object is the instant messaging group "work communication group", the second object is the cloud file A, and the above process is performed by the client.
  • the client can display the group chat instant messaging message and related information of the instant messaging group.
  • the display area may include a title display area 210 , a message display area 220 and an operation area 230 .
  • the title display area 210 is used for displaying basic information of the instant messaging group.
  • the title display area 210 displays the group name “work communication group” and the group avatar of the instant messaging group.
  • the title display area 210 may further include a jump control 211 for controlling the client to jump to other interfaces, for example, may be used to jump to an interface displaying a label adding control, that is, the interface shown in FIG. 3 .
  • the message display area 220 may be used to display group chat instant messaging messages.
  • the client terminal may display the message body together with the corresponding user information.
  • the group chat instant messaging message 221 includes an avatar display area 221-1, a logo display area 221-2 and a text display area 221-3.
  • the avatar display area 221-1 is used to display the avatar of the user who sent the group chat instant message
  • the identification display area 221-2 is used to display the identity of the user who sent the group chat instant message, for example, it can be the user's ID or nickname.
  • the text display area 221-3 is used to display the text of the group chat instant messaging message published by the user. In the embodiment shown in FIG. 2, the text of the group chat instant messaging message 221 is "please pay attention".
  • the operation area 230 may include an input box 231 and a send control 232 .
  • the input box 231 is used for inputting a group chat instant message
  • the sending control 232 is used for sending the group chat instant message to be sent in the input box 231 .
  • the user can trigger a tag adding operation to the first object through the tag adding control.
  • the client terminal can display the label adding control in the interface of the instant messaging group (for example, the interface that displays the instant messaging messages of the group chat), or can jump to other interfaces based on the jumping operation triggered by the user, and in the interface. Display label add controls.
  • the chat interface of the instant messaging chat group does not include a tag adding control for adding a tag to the group, and the user can click the jump control 211 to control the client to display the instant messaging group
  • a setting interface, which includes a label adding control, is used to trigger a label adding operation.
  • the display area of the client terminal may include a title display area 310 , a position adjustment control 320 , an avatar adjustment control 330 , a name adjustment control 340 and a label adding control 350 .
  • the title display area 310 is used to display basic information and basic operation controls of the setting interface. For example, in the embodiment shown in FIG. 3, the title display area 310 displays the name of the setting interface as “settings-work communication group”, indicating that the setting interface is used to set the relevant information of the instant messaging group whose group name is “work communication group” information.
  • the position adjustment control 320 is used to adjust the relative position of the currently located interface and the display area 300 .
  • the position adjustment control 320 includes a chute 321 and a slider control 322 .
  • the slider control 322 can move up and down in the chute 321 , so as to adjust the relative position of the adjustment setting interface and the display area 300 .
  • the avatar adjustment control 330 can be used to display the avatar of the instant messaging group, and can also be used to adjust the avatar of the instant messaging group. For example, when the user wants to modify the group avatar of the instant messaging group "work communication group", the user can click the position corresponding to the avatar adjustment control 330 on the client screen, thereby triggering the avatar replacement operation and adjusting the avatar of the instant messaging group. Group avatars.
  • the name adjustment control 340 can be used to display the group name of the IM group, and can also be used to adjust the name of the IM group.
  • the name adjustment control 340 includes annotation information 341 , a name display area 342 and an edit control 343 .
  • the label information 341 is used to prompt the user name display area 342 to display the name of the IM group
  • the name display area 342 is used to display the name of the IM group
  • the edit control 343 is used to trigger a name change operation. For example, when the user wants to modify the group name of the instant messaging group "work communication group", the user can click the edit control 343 in the name adjustment control 340 on the client screen to trigger the name change operation and adjust the name of the instant messaging group. Group name.
  • the label adding control 350 may be used to add labels to the instant messaging group, may also be used to display the labels corresponding to the instant messaging groups, and may also be used to adjust the labels corresponding to the instant messaging groups.
  • the label adding control 350 includes label information 351 , a label display area 352 and a label adding control 353 .
  • the label information 351 is used to prompt the user that the content displayed in the label display area 352 is the label corresponding to the instant messaging group.
  • the label display area 352 is used for displaying labels corresponding to the instant messaging group.
  • the label display area 342 may display "no label for now".
  • the tag addition control 353 can be used to trigger a tag addition operation.
  • the label adding control 353 can also be used to trigger a label deletion operation or a label change operation.
  • the tag addition control 353 may include an indication message for prompting the user that the tag addition control 353 may be used to trigger a tag addition operation, or that the tag addition control 353 may be used to trigger a tag deletion operation or a tag change operation.
  • the instruction message of the tag adding control 353 can be "Add”, which is used to prompt the user that the tag adding control 353 can be used to trigger the tag adding operation; when the instant messaging group has a tag, the tag The instruction message of the adding control 353 may be "Add”, which is used to prompt the user that the labeling control 353 may be used to trigger a label adding operation, a label changing operation or a label deleting operation.
  • a tag adding operation triggered for the instant messaging group "work communication group” can be sent to the client by triggering the label adding control 353 .
  • the client After receiving the tag adding operation triggered by the user, the client can generate a correspondence between the instant messaging group "work communication group” and the target tag, that is, the first correspondence.
  • the client can determine whether there is an associated object in the instant messaging group "work communication group". If the user shares cloud file A in the "work exchange group", the client can determine that cloud file A is associated with the instant messaging group "work exchange group”. Then, the client can determine whether the user who triggers the tag adding operation (for example, the user currently logged in to the client) has the permission to add the tag of cloud file A, and if so, the client can generate the corresponding relationship between cloud file A and the target tag, which is Cloud file A adds tags.
  • the user who triggers the tag adding operation for example, the user currently logged in to the client
  • the client When generating the corresponding relationship between cloud file A and target tag, the client can set the tag type of the target tag in the corresponding relationship to the automatic addition type, indicating that the target tag of cloud file A is added by the client based on tags triggered by other objects. Actions are added automatically.
  • the client may also display the first object and the target label in association, and/or display the second object and the target label in association.
  • the "user” described in this embodiment and the “user” described in the embodiment shown in FIG. 2 may be the same user or different users.
  • the "user” described in this embodiment may be different from the "user” described in the previous embodiment. That is, for multiple users collaborating under the same project, when one user adds a tag to an object in the project, the client can automatically add tags to other related objects, and send tags to other users among the multiple users. Display labels.
  • the client terminal Before displaying the target tag, the first object with the target tag, and the second object, it may be determined whether the current user logging in to the client belongs to the sharing scope.
  • the sharing scope is a preset user who has viewing rights of the target tag, the first object, and the second object. If the user currently logging in to the client terminal belongs to a user within the sharing range, the presentation target tag and the first object may be associated with the user, and the imaging target tag and the second object may also be associated with the user.
  • the client terminal may display the target tag in association with the interface displaying the first object, and may also display the second object in association in the interface displaying the target tag.
  • the client terminal may display the target label in the interface corresponding to the display of the first object or the second object, and may also jump to the label display interface of the target label based on the user's operation. Details are given below.
  • the client may display the target label in the interface corresponding to the display of the first object or the second object. Specifically, the client may display the target label in the interface displaying the first object or the second object. For example, assuming that the first object is an instant messaging group, the client can display the target label of the instant messaging group in the interface for displaying the title of the instant messaging group (eg, the title display interface 210 in FIG. 2 ). Of course, in some other implementation manners, the client may also display a label viewing control on the interface of the first object or the second object. After receiving the label viewing operation triggered by the user on the label viewing control, display the target label.
  • the client may jump to the label display interface of the target label based on the user's operation, and display the first object and the second object in the label display interface. Details are given below.
  • the client terminal may display a tab browsing interface according to a jump operation triggered by the user, and display at least one tab that the user can view (for example, the user has viewing authority to view) on the tab browsing interface.
  • the user can control the client to jump to the label display page corresponding to the label.
  • the client can display at least one object with the label.
  • the user when a user wants to view an object with a target tag, the user can first trigger a jump operation to control the client to display the tag browsing interface. Then, the user can operate the target label displayed in the label browsing interface, and control the client to further display the label display interface of the target label, so as to view the object with the target label in the label display interface of the target label.
  • the label viewing control may be located on the initial interface of the client, or may be located on any other interface.
  • the user can trigger the label viewing operation on the initial interface of the client or any other interface.
  • the display area may include a title display area 410 , a message display area 420 and a control display area 430 .
  • the title display area 410 is used to display the basic information of the client. For example, in FIG. 4 , the title display area 410 displays the name of the software running on the client “software X”.
  • the message display area 420 is used for displaying group chat instant messaging messages. For the introduction of the details in the message display area 420, reference may be made to the above, which will not be repeated here.
  • the control display area 430 is used to display at least one operation control.
  • the control display area 430 includes a message view control 431 , an address book view control 432 and a jump control 433 .
  • the message viewing control 431 is used to make the client display the group chat instant messaging message after being triggered.
  • the message viewing control 431 is in a state that has been triggered.
  • the address book viewing control 432 is used to cause the client to display the address book after being triggered.
  • the address book viewing control 432 is not triggered.
  • the jump control 433 is used to make the client display at least one label after being triggered. In the embodiment shown in FIG. 4 , the jump 433 is not triggered.
  • the client can receive the jump operation triggered by the user, so as to jump to the tab browsing interface.
  • the tab browsing interface may be as shown in FIG. 5 .
  • the display area may include a title display area 510 , a control display area 520 , a search control 530 , a sorting information display area 540 and a label display area 550 .
  • the title display area 510 is used to display the basic information of the client; the control display area 520 includes a jump control 521 .
  • the jump control 521 is in a triggered state;
  • the search control 530 is used to receive the keyword input by the user and search for tags matching the keyword;
  • the sorting information display area 540 is used to The sorting rules for each tab card in the tab display area 550 are displayed.
  • the content displayed in the sorting information display area 540 is “Recent”, indicating that the sorting rule of the tags in the tag display area 550 is sorting by tag access time, and the last accessed tag is ranked first.
  • the label display area 550 may be used to display one or more label cards, and each label card may display information related to a label.
  • the label display area 550 includes a first label card 551 , a second label card 552 , a third label card 553 and a fourth label card 854 that is not fully displayed.
  • the first label card 551 includes a color identification area 551-1 and a label name display area 551-2. The color displayed in the color identification area 551-1 is used to represent the creator of the first label 551, and the label name display area 551-2 is used to display the name of the first label 551.
  • the color corresponding to the first label card 551 is black, indicating that the label “meeting” currently displayed on the first label card 551 is created by the user currently logging in to the client.
  • the color displayed in the color identification area 551-1 may also be used to represent other content, which is not specifically limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the user can trigger an operation on any label, thereby controlling the client to display at least one object with the label.
  • the client can display at least one object with the same tag in a list.
  • the display area may include a title display area 610, a control display area 620 and a label display area 630.
  • the description about the title display area 610 and the control display area 620 can refer to the above, and details are not repeated here.
  • the label display area 630 includes a label switch control 631, a label name display area 632, a label field display area 633, and at least one object information display area.
  • the tab switching control 631 is used to switch to other tabs.
  • the tag switching control 631 can be triggered; the tag name display area 632 is used to display the names of the tags.
  • the user can determine, according to the label name display area 632, that the currently displayed object belongs to the label "meeting".
  • the tab field display area 633 can reflect the tab field from which the currently displayed object comes from, and can also be used to switch the display of objects from other tab fields.
  • the tag field display area 633 includes a first tag field name 633-1, a second tag field name 633-2, and label information 633-3.
  • the first tag field name 633-1 is "message", indicating that the object from this tag field is an instant messaging message;
  • the second tag field name 633-2 is "group”, indicating that the object originating from this tag field is Instant messaging group;
  • label information 633-3 is used to label the label field to which the object currently displayed by the client belongs.
  • the label information 633-3 is related to the first label field name 633-1, indicating that the object currently displayed by the client comes from the label field “Instant Messaging Message”.
  • the label display area 630 may not include the label field display area 633 .
  • the label display area 630 may include one or more object display areas, and each object display area may be used to display an object with a target label.
  • the following description will be given by taking the label display area 630 including the object display area 634 as an example.
  • the object display area 634 may include that the avatar display is triggered by the delete operation triggered by the user on the first object
  • the avatar display area 634-1 is used to display the avatar of the user who sent the instant messaging message.
  • the content display area 634-2 can display the specific content of the instant messaging message.
  • the content display area 634-2 may display part of the instant messaging messages, such as the first ten characters of the messages and the like.
  • the object information display area 634-3 is used to display other information of the instant messaging message. For example, in the embodiment shown in FIG.
  • the object information display area 634-3 displays the time when the instant messaging message was sent.
  • the object information display area 634-3 may also display other information, for example, may display information such as the instant messaging group to which the instant messaging message belongs.
  • the information block of the object may be displayed in the object display area, for example, the summary information of the object may be displayed.
  • the label display area 630 may further include indication information for prompting the user for the content displayed in each display area in the object display area.
  • the label display area 630 includes two indication information of "message content” and "recently sent".
  • the prompt information “message content” is used to prompt the user that the corresponding position in the object display area below the user is used to display the content of the instant messaging message.
  • the prompt message "Recently Sent” is used to prompt the user that the objects displayed in the object display areas below the user are arranged in the order of the time of sending instant messaging messages.
  • the user can view at least one object with a target label.
  • some tags are objects that are added according to a tag adding operation for the object, and some tags are objects that are automatically added according to a tag adding operation for other objects.
  • the objects displayed in the label display interface include both the first object and the second object associated with the first object.
  • the label display interface may include a label type display area, and the method used to reflect the label of the object is added.
  • the object display area 634 may include a label type display area 634-4, indicating that the label of the instant messaging message displayed in the object display area 634 is automatically added, that is, the object has The label type "Meeting" is auto-added.
  • the multiple objects with the same target tag may include at least two first objects, and second objects respectively associated with the at least two first objects, that is, at least two second objects
  • the tags can be added based on different tag addition operations.
  • the objects with target tags may include a first object A and a first object B, and a second object C associated with the first object A and a second object D associated with the first object B.
  • the client may display a filter control in the label display interface.
  • the filter control is used to filter out second objects associated with one or more of the first objects.
  • a filter operation can be triggered on the filter control in the label display interface.
  • the target first object may be determined according to the screening operation, and a second object associated with the target first object is displayed.
  • the tab display interface may include filter controls 640 .
  • the candidate interface 650 may include a first filter control 651, a second filter control 652, a third filter control 653, and a fourth filter control.
  • the first filter control 651 is used to control the display of second objects associated with all the first objects;
  • the second filter control 652 is used to control the display of second objects associated with the first object "group A";
  • the third The filter control 653 is used to control the display of the second object associated with the first object "Group B";
  • the fourth filter control 654 is used to control the client to display the second object associated with the first object "Group C".
  • the candidate interface 650 further includes a first state display area 655 , a second state display area 656 , a third state display area 657 and a fourth state display area 658 .
  • the first state display area 655 is used to display the triggering situation of the first filter control 651;
  • the second state display area 656 is used to display the trigger situation of the second filter control 652;
  • the third state display area 657 is used to display the first filter The trigger condition of the control 653 ;
  • the fourth state display area 658 is used to display the trigger condition of the fourth filter control 654 .
  • the first filter control 651 and the third filter control 653 are in an untriggered state
  • the second filter control 652 and the fourth filter control 654 are in a triggered state, indicating that the object is displayed
  • the objects displayed in area 634 include the second object associated with the first object "Group A” and the first object "Group C", excluding the second object associated with the first object "Group B”.
  • the information interaction method provided by the embodiments of the present application has been introduced above.
  • a target tag can be added to the first object and at least one second object associated with the first object according to the tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object.
  • the embodiment of the present application also provides a corresponding label deletion method for deleting the target label of the second object. Details are given below.
  • FIG. 7 is a schematic flowchart of a method for deleting a label provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the method may be executed by a client or a server, and the client (or server) may be the same as the client (or the server) in the embodiment shown in FIG. server) is the same client (or server), or it can be a different client (or server).
  • the user described in this embodiment and the user described above may be the same user, or may be different users.
  • the label deletion method provided in the embodiment of the present application specifically includes the following steps:
  • the "user" described in this embodiment may be different from the "user” described in the preceding embodiments. That is, for multiple users cooperating under the same project, the user can delete the tag added by other users to the object, and the client can automatically delete the same tag of other objects associated with the object based on the deletion of the object tag.
  • S701 Receive a label deletion operation triggered by a user on the first object.
  • the client or the server may receive a tag deletion operation triggered by the user on the first object, so as to delete the target tags of the first object and the second object according to the tag deletion operation.
  • the first object can be any one of folders, cloud files, local files, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages, and instant messaging groups
  • the second object can be It is any object associated with the first object among objects such as folders, cloud files, local files, schedules, tasks, instant messaging messages, and instant messaging groups.
  • the tag deletion operation may be triggered by a target tag of the first object, or may be triggered by a deletion operation triggered by a user on the first object.
  • a target tag of the first object or may be triggered by a deletion operation triggered by a user on the first object.
  • the tag deletion operation is triggered by the user on the target tag of the first object. That is, the purpose of triggering the tag deletion operation by the user is to delete the target tag of the first object, but not to delete the first object or the second object.
  • the label deletion operation may be triggered by the user on the label deletion control. Wherein, the label delete control is used to delete the target label of the first object.
  • the tag deletion operation is triggered by the user on the target tag of the first object, the user can trigger the tag deletion operation in the interface displaying the first object, or trigger the tag deletion operation in the interface displaying the target tag. Both cases are described below.
  • the user triggers the tag deletion operation through the tag deletion control in the interface displaying the first object.
  • the client terminal may display a tag deletion control on the interface displaying the first object, and the user may trigger a tag deletion operation by clicking the tag deletion control displayed on the client terminal.
  • the client may display a tag deletion control in the interface displaying the instant messaging group, for example, the tag deletion control may be displayed in the interface shown in FIG. 2 or FIG. 3 .
  • the user can trigger the tag deletion operation by clicking the tag deletion control displayed on the client side.
  • the label deletion control may be used to delete the target label of the first object, or may be used to delete all labels of the first object.
  • the client can also display the label deletion control based on the display operation triggered by the user, so that the user can trigger the label deletion operation on the label deletion control. That is, the client can hide the label deletion control first, and display the label addition control based on the display operation triggered by the user, so that the user can trigger the label deletion operation through the label deletion control.
  • the client may not display the label deletion control in the interface displaying the folder.
  • a list of operation controls is displayed, and the list of operation controls includes a label deletion control.
  • the user triggers the tag deletion operation in the interface displaying the target tag.
  • the client terminal may display a label deletion control in the label display interface as shown in Figure 6-b or Figure 6-c, so that the user can trigger a label deletion operation through the label deletion control.
  • the object display area 634 may include the tag deletion control 634-5.
  • the user can trigger a label deletion operation through the label deletion control 634-5, and the label deletion operation is used to delete the label "meeting" of the instant communication message "the topic of the meeting to be discussed is.".
  • the second implementation is described below.
  • the first object may be deleted based on the deletion operation triggered by the user. Based on this, the corresponding relationship between the first object and the target tag can also be deleted, that is, the tag deletion operation is triggered by a deletion operation triggered by the user on the first object.
  • the user may trigger a deletion operation on the first object, and after receiving the deletion operation triggered by the user, it is determined whether the first object has a tag based on the deletion operation. If so, the tag deletion operation can be acquired according to the deletion operation triggered by the user, so that the tag of the first object is deleted according to the tag deletion operation.
  • the tag deletion operation when the tag deletion operation is triggered by the deletion operation on the first object, the tag deletion operation can be used to delete the target tag of the first object, and can also be used to delete the target tag of the first object. other labels.
  • the first correspondence may be deleted according to the label deletion operation.
  • the first correspondence is the correspondence between the first object and the target label.
  • the first object and the target label may be determined according to the label deletion operation, so as to determine the first correspondence.
  • the second correspondence is the correspondence between the second object and the target label, and the second object is an object associated with the aforementioned second object.
  • first object, the second object, the first correspondence and the second correspondence reference may be made to the introduction of the embodiment shown in FIG. 2 , and details are not repeated here.
  • the label of the first object can be deleted based on the label deletion operation on the first object, and the label of the second object can be automatically deleted based on "the label of the first object is deleted".
  • the user wants to delete tags of multiple objects in batches, he only needs to trigger the tag deletion operation for each of the first objects, and does not need to trigger the tag deletion operation for each object separately.
  • the deletion of the second correspondence is automatically performed based on the deletion of the first correspondence. Therefore, before deleting the second correspondence, the second correspondence to be deleted may be determined first. Specifically, the first corresponding relationship may be determined according to the label deletion operation, and then the second corresponding relationship may be determined according to the first corresponding relationship, thereby deleting the second corresponding relationship.
  • the client or the server may determine the second correspondence in two different ways. They are introduced separately below.
  • the second object may be determined according to the first object
  • the target label may be determined according to the first correspondence
  • the second correspondence may be determined and deleted according to the second object and the target label.
  • the association relationship between the second object and the first object may be recorded when the second object is received.
  • the second object associated with the first object may be determined according to the recorded association relationship.
  • the target tag to be deleted may also be determined according to the first correspondence. After the target label and the second object are determined, the correspondence between the target label and the second object, that is, the second correspondence, may be deleted.
  • the target tag to be deleted may be determined first, and a second object associated with the first object may be screened out from the objects with the target tag, and then the second object and the target tag may be determined and analyzed Delete the second correspondence.
  • the target label may be determined according to the first correspondence, and at least one object corresponding to the target label is acquired. Next, it can be determined one by one whether each object in the at least one object is associated with the first object. If an object with a target tag is associated with the first object, the object can be determined as the second object, thereby deleting the target tag of the second object.
  • the client or the server can determine whether the second correspondence is automatically generated, that is, whether the second correspondence is generated based on the tag addition operation triggered by the first object. If the second corresponding relationship is automatically generated, the second corresponding relationship can be automatically deleted based on the deletion of the first corresponding relationship; if the second corresponding relationship is not automatically generated, it means that the user has triggered the tag adding operation to the second object alone, and can be retained The second correspondence.
  • the tag type of the target tag in the second corresponding relationship is an automatically added type. If the tag type of the target tag in the second correspondence is the automatic addition type, it means that the second correspondence is automatically generated based on the operation of adding tags triggered by the first object. The label deletion operation is automatically deleted, and the client or server may delete the second correspondence according to the foregoing label deletion operation. On the contrary, if the tag type of the target tag in the second correspondence relationship is not an automatically added type, the client or the server may not delete the second correspondence relationship. For example, if the tag type of the target tag in the second correspondence relationship is a manual addition type, it means that the second correspondence relationship is generated based on a tag addition operation triggered by the user on the second object, and the second correspondence relationship can be retained.
  • the second object may be associated with multiple objects. Then, if the user deletes the target label of any one of the objects, and does not delete the target label of other objects, the corresponding relationship between the second object and the target label can be retained. If all target tags of all objects associated with the second object are deleted, the second correspondence may be deleted.
  • the first object is associated with the second object
  • the third object is also associated with the second object
  • the first object, the second object, and the third object all have target tags.
  • the correspondence between the third object and the target label is the third correspondence.
  • the client or server may delete the first correspondence according to the tag deletion operation, and determine the second object and the second correspondence according to the first correspondence. Next, it can be determined whether the second object is associated with other objects. Since the second object is also associated with the third object, the second corresponding relationship can be retained, and the target label of the second object is not deleted.
  • the target object set includes at least one object (eg, a first object and a third object) with a target tag. If the second object is associated with any object in the target object set except the first object and the second object, the second correspondence can be retained. If the second object is not associated with any object in the target object set, the second corresponding relationship can be deleted. Before deleting the second correspondence, the second object may be displayed in the label display interface of the target label.
  • the user may send wrong messages or files in the instant messaging software, which may easily cause trouble to other users in the instant messaging group.
  • the instant messaging software can have a recall function, and the user can trigger a recall operation on the sent instant messaging messages or files, thereby deleting the wrongly sent instant messaging messages or files.
  • the information interaction method provided by the embodiment of the present application can automatically add a target tag to the second object associated with the first object. Then, when the first object is an instant messaging group, if the user sends a wrong instant messaging message or file in the instant messaging group, the client or server may automatically add a target tag to the instant messaging message or file. However, since the instant messaging message or file is sent to the instant messaging group by mistake, the user may not actually want to target the instant messaging message or file.
  • the client or the server may also delete the automatically generated second correspondence according to a withdrawal operation triggered by the user.
  • FIG. 8 is another schematic flowchart of a label deletion method provided by an embodiment of the present application, and the method specifically includes the following steps:
  • S801 Receive a first withdrawal operation triggered by a user.
  • the client or the server may first receive a first withdraw operation triggered by the user, where the first withdraw operation is used to release the association between the first object and the second object.
  • the first object is an instant messaging group
  • releasing the association between the first object and the second object is equivalent to withdrawing the second object from the instant messaging group.
  • the user can trigger the first withdrawal operation through the withdrawal control.
  • the client may display a retraction control corresponding to the second object based on the user's operation.
  • the client may display the retraction control corresponding to the second object based on the user's right-click operation or long-press operation Withdraw control.
  • the client terminal may also directly display a retraction control corresponding to the second object in the interface displaying the second object, so that the user can trigger the first retraction operation through the retraction control.
  • the client or server may delete the association relationship between the first object and the second object according to the first recall operation, and cancel the deletion based on the association relationship between the first object and the second object The second correspondence.
  • the target tag of the second object may also be deleted based on "the second object is withdrawn from the first object". In this way, the target label of the second object is automatically deleted according to the user's first withdrawal operation, and the user does not need to trigger the label deletion operation to delete the target label of the second object after withdrawing the second object.
  • the second correspondence can be automatically deleted according to the first recall operation; if the second object is associated with any object with the target label, the second correspondence may not be automatically deleted relation.
  • the client or the server may delete the association relationship between the first object and the second object according to the first recall operation. If the association relationship between the second object and the third object is also released, the second corresponding relationship may be automatically deleted based on the release of the association relationship between the second object and the third object. Similarly, if a tag deletion operation triggered on the third object is received, the second correspondence can be automatically deleted. If neither the second recall operation nor the tag deletion operation triggered on the third object is received, the target tag of the second object may be retained. Optionally, the second object may be displayed on the label display interface of the target label.
  • the instant messaging group A and the instant messaging group B have the label X, and the user sends the cloud file Y in both the instant messaging group A and the instant messaging group B. Then, if the user wants to withdraw the cloud file Y in the instant messaging group A, a first withdraw operation can be triggered, and the first withdrawing operation is used to contact the association relationship between the instant messaging group A and the cloud file Y. After receiving the first recall operation, since cloud file Y is also associated with instant messaging group B, the corresponding relationship between cloud file Y and label X can be retained, and the relationship between cloud file Y and instant messaging group A can be released. connection relation.
  • the cloud file Y and the target object set exclude the first object It is not associated with other objects except the third object, and the second correspondence can be deleted.
  • FIG. 9 is a schematic structural diagram of an information interaction apparatus provided by an embodiment of the present application. This embodiment can be applied to the case where a target tag is added to a first object in a client, and a target tag is automatically added to a second object. Specifically, it includes a receiving module 910 , a first generating module 920 and a second generating module 930 .
  • the receiving module 910 is configured to receive a tag adding operation triggered by the user on the first object.
  • the first generating module 920 is configured to generate a first correspondence according to the label adding operation, where the first correspondence is a correspondence between a target label and the first object.
  • the second generation module 930 is configured to generate a second correspondence in response to generating the first correspondence, where the second correspondence is a correspondence between the target label and a second object, and the second object is the object associated with the first object.
  • the apparatus for information interaction provided by the embodiment of the present disclosure can execute the information interaction method provided by any embodiment of the present disclosure, and has functional modules and beneficial effects corresponding to the method for performing information interaction. It is worth noting that, in the above-mentioned embodiment of the apparatus for information interaction, the units and modules included are only divided according to functional logic, but are not limited to the above-mentioned division, as long as the corresponding functions can be realized; in addition, The specific names of the functional units are only for the convenience of distinguishing from each other, and are not used to limit the protection scope of the present disclosure.
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic structural diagram of an information interaction apparatus provided by an embodiment of the present application. This embodiment can be applied to the case where the target label of the first object is deleted in the client and the target label of the second object is automatically deleted. Specifically, it includes a receiving module 1010 , a first deleting module 1020 and a second deleting module 1030 .
  • the receiving module 1010 is configured to receive a tag deletion operation triggered by a user on the first object.
  • the first deletion module 1020 is configured to delete a first correspondence according to the label deletion operation, where the first correspondence is a correspondence between a target label and the first object.
  • the second deletion module 1030 is configured to delete a second correspondence in response to deleting the first correspondence, where the second correspondence is the correspondence between the target label and a second object, the second object is the object associated with the first object.
  • the apparatus for information interaction provided by the embodiment of the present disclosure can execute the information interaction method provided by any embodiment of the present disclosure, and has functional modules and beneficial effects corresponding to the method for performing information interaction. It is worth noting that, in the above-mentioned embodiment of the apparatus for information interaction, the units and modules included are only divided according to functional logic, but are not limited to the above-mentioned division, as long as the corresponding functions can be realized; in addition, The specific names of the functional units are only for the convenience of distinguishing from each other, and are not used to limit the protection scope of the present disclosure.
  • FIG. 11 it shows a schematic structural diagram of an electronic device (eg, a terminal device or a server running a client) 1100 suitable for implementing an embodiment of the present disclosure.
  • Terminal devices in the embodiments of the present disclosure may include, but are not limited to, such as mobile phones, notebook computers, digital broadcast receivers, PDAs (personal digital assistants), PADs (tablets), PMPs (portable multimedia players), vehicle-mounted terminals (eg, mobile terminals such as in-vehicle navigation terminals), etc., and stationary terminals such as digital TVs, desktop computers, and the like.
  • the electronic device shown in FIG. 11 is only an example, and should not impose any limitation on the function and scope of use of the embodiments of the present disclosure.
  • an electronic device 1100 may include a processing device (eg, a central processing unit, a graphics processor, etc.) 1101 that may be loaded into random access according to a program stored in a read only memory (ROM) 1102 or from a storage device 1108 Various appropriate actions and processes are executed by the programs in the memory (RAM) 1103 . In the RAM 1103, various programs and data necessary for the operation of the electronic device 1100 are also stored.
  • the processing device 1101, the ROM 1102, and the RAM 1103 are connected to each other through a bus 1104.
  • An input/output (I/O) interface 1105 is also connected to the bus 1104 .
  • the following devices can be connected to the I/O interface 1105: input devices 1106 including, for example, a touch screen, touchpad, keyboard, mouse, camera, microphone, accelerometer, gyroscope, etc.; including, for example, a liquid crystal display (LCD), speakers, vibration An output device 1107 such as a computer; a storage device 1108 including, for example, a magnetic tape, a hard disk, etc.; and a communication device 1109. Communication means 1109 may allow electronic device 1100 to communicate wirelessly or by wire with other devices to exchange data.
  • FIG. 11 shows an electronic device 1100 having various means, it should be understood that not all of the illustrated means are required to be implemented or provided. More or fewer devices may alternatively be implemented or provided.
  • embodiments of the present disclosure include a computer program product comprising a computer program carried on a non-transitory computer readable medium, the computer program containing program code for performing the method illustrated in the flowchart.
  • the computer program may be downloaded and installed from the network via the communication device 1109, or from the storage device 1108, or from the ROM 1102.
  • the processing apparatus 1101 the above-mentioned functions defined in the methods of the embodiments of the present disclosure are executed.
  • the electronic device provided by the embodiments of the present disclosure, the information interaction method and the label deletion method provided by the above-mentioned embodiments belong to the same inventive concept. It has the same beneficial effect as the above-mentioned embodiment.
  • Embodiments of the present disclosure provide a computer storage medium on which a computer program is stored, and when the program is executed by a processor, the information interaction method or the label deletion method provided by the foregoing embodiments is implemented.
  • the computer-readable medium mentioned above in the present disclosure may be a computer-readable signal medium or a computer-readable storage medium, or any combination of the above two.
  • the computer-readable storage medium can be, for example, but not limited to, an electrical, magnetic, optical, electromagnetic, infrared, or semiconductor system, apparatus or device, or a combination of any of the above. More specific examples of computer readable storage media may include, but are not limited to, electrical connections with one or more wires, portable computer disks, hard disks, random access memory (RAM), read only memory (ROM), erasable Programmable read only memory (EPROM or flash memory), fiber optics, portable compact disk read only memory (CD-ROM), optical storage devices, magnetic storage devices, or any suitable combination of the foregoing.
  • a computer-readable storage medium may be any tangible medium that contains or stores a program that can be used by or in conjunction with an instruction execution system, apparatus, or device.
  • a computer-readable signal medium may include a data signal propagated in baseband or as part of a carrier wave with computer-readable program code embodied thereon. Such propagated data signals may take a variety of forms, including but not limited to electromagnetic signals, optical signals, or any suitable combination of the foregoing.
  • a computer-readable signal medium can also be any computer-readable medium other than a computer-readable storage medium that can transmit, propagate, or transport the program for use by or in connection with the instruction execution system, apparatus, or device .
  • Program code embodied on a computer readable medium may be transmitted using any suitable medium including, but not limited to, electrical wire, optical fiber cable, RF (radio frequency), etc., or any suitable combination of the foregoing.
  • the client and server can use any currently known or future developed network protocol such as HTTP (HyperText Transfer Protocol) to communicate, and can communicate with digital data in any form or medium Communication (eg, a communication network) interconnects.
  • HTTP HyperText Transfer Protocol
  • Examples of communication networks include local area networks (“LAN”), wide area networks (“WAN”), the Internet (eg, the Internet), and peer-to-peer networks (eg, ad hoc peer-to-peer networks), as well as any currently known or future development network of.
  • the above-mentioned computer-readable medium may be included in the above-mentioned electronic device; or may exist alone without being assembled into the electronic device.
  • the computer-readable medium carries one or more programs, and when the one or more programs are executed by the electronic device, the electronic device: receives a tag adding operation triggered by a user on the first object; adds an operation according to the tag generating a first correspondence, where the first correspondence is the correspondence between the target label and the first object; in response to generating the first correspondence, generating a second correspondence, where the second correspondence is Correspondence between the target tag and a second object, where the second object is an object associated with the first object.
  • the electronic device receive a label deletion operation triggered by the user on the first object; delete a first correspondence according to the label deletion operation, where the first correspondence is the correspondence between the target label and the first object ; In response to deleting the first corresponding relationship, delete the second corresponding relationship, the second corresponding relationship is the corresponding relationship between the target label and the second object, the second object is with the first object associated object.
  • Computer program code for performing operations of the present disclosure may be written in one or more programming languages, including but not limited to object-oriented programming languages—such as Java, Smalltalk, C++, and This includes conventional procedural programming languages - such as the "C" language or similar programming languages.
  • the program code may execute entirely on the user's computer, partly on the user's computer, as a stand-alone software package, partly on the user's computer and partly on a remote computer, or entirely on the remote computer or server.
  • the remote computer may be connected to the user's computer through any kind of network, including a local area network (LAN) or a wide area network (WAN), or may be connected to an external computer (eg, using an Internet service provider through Internet connection).
  • LAN local area network
  • WAN wide area network
  • each block in the flowchart or block diagrams may represent a module, segment, or portion of code that contains one or more logical functions for implementing the specified functions executable instructions.
  • the functions noted in the blocks may occur out of the order noted in the figures. For example, two blocks shown in succession may, in fact, be executed substantially concurrently, or the blocks may sometimes be executed in the reverse order, depending upon the functionality involved.
  • each block of the block diagrams and/or flowchart illustrations, and combinations of blocks in the block diagrams and/or flowchart illustrations can be implemented in dedicated hardware-based systems that perform the specified functions or operations , or can be implemented in a combination of dedicated hardware and computer instructions.
  • the units involved in the embodiments of the present disclosure may be implemented in a software manner, and may also be implemented in a hardware manner. Wherein, the name of the unit does not constitute a limitation of the unit itself under certain circumstances, for example, the editable content display unit may also be described as an "editing unit".
  • exemplary types of hardware logic components include: Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs), Application Specific Integrated Circuits (ASICs), Application Specific Standard Products (ASSPs), Systems on Chips (SOCs), Complex Programmable Logical Devices (CPLDs) and more.
  • FPGAs Field Programmable Gate Arrays
  • ASICs Application Specific Integrated Circuits
  • ASSPs Application Specific Standard Products
  • SOCs Systems on Chips
  • CPLDs Complex Programmable Logical Devices
  • a machine-readable medium may be a tangible medium that may contain or store a program for use by or in connection with the instruction execution system, apparatus or device.
  • the machine-readable medium may be a machine-readable signal medium or a machine-readable storage medium.
  • Machine-readable media may include, but are not limited to, electronic, magnetic, optical, electromagnetic, infrared, or semiconductor systems, devices, or devices, or any suitable combination of the foregoing.
  • machine-readable storage media would include one or more wire-based electrical connections, portable computer disks, hard disks, random access memory (RAM), read only memory (ROM), erasable programmable read only memory (EPROM or flash memory), fiber optics, compact disk read only memory (CD-ROM), optical storage, magnetic storage, or any suitable combination of the foregoing.
  • RAM random access memory
  • ROM read only memory
  • EPROM or flash memory erasable programmable read only memory
  • CD-ROM compact disk read only memory
  • magnetic storage or any suitable combination of the foregoing.
  • tasks can also be tagged.
  • a user if he participates in multiple projects completed by multiple people, the user not only needs to view the tasks related to a certain project, but also concentrates the tasks related to himself. View and manage requirements. If the user needs to view the tasks related to him/herself, he needs to open the pages of the tags associated with the respective tasks to view the respective tasks. User operations are cumbersome and inefficient.
  • the inventor of the present application found that for a user, there may be many tasks related to it. If the user needs to view tasks related to himself, he needs to open the pages associated with the tags of each task to view the tasks related to him. the respective tasks. For example, there are three tasks related to user A, and these three tasks have labels 1, 2 and 3 respectively. Then user A needs to open the page corresponding to tag 1 to view task 1, user A needs to open the page corresponding to tag 2 to view task 2, and user A needs to open the page corresponding to tag 3 to view task 3. User operations are cumbersome and inefficient.
  • embodiments of the present application provide a task-based information processing method and apparatus.
  • FIG. 12 this figure is a schematic flowchart of a task-based information processing method provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the method provided by the embodiment of the present application may be executed by a client, and in the embodiment of the present application, a target application may be installed on the client.
  • the first user mentioned in the embodiments of the present application refers to the user corresponding to the account that logs in the target application program on the client.
  • FIG. 13 , FIG. 15 a , FIG. 15 b , and FIG. 15 c are only shown for the convenience of understanding the contents related to the embodiments of the present application, and do not constitute limitations to the embodiments of the present application. .
  • the pages shown in FIG. 13 , FIG. 15 a , FIG. 15 b , and FIG. 15 c may also include other content, which is not specifically limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the method shown in FIG. 12 may include, for example, the following steps: S1201-S1202.
  • S1201 Acquire at least one task related to the first user and having a tag, where the tag is an additional attribute of the at least one task, and the tag is shared within a preset range determined by the authority of the tag.
  • the task related to the first user may include three situations.
  • the first case is a task created by the first user, that is, a task whose creator is the first user.
  • the second case is a task where the first user is the executor. For example, created by a second user and specifying a task to be performed by a performer including the first user. As another example, it is created by the first user itself, and specifies a task to be performed by the first user.
  • the third case is the task that the first user focuses on. For example, the first user is a project manager, who pays attention to the tasks related to the project to know the execution progress of the project.
  • the tag is not a tag that can only be used locally on the client of the first user, but a tag that can be shared within a certain range.
  • the sharing scope of the tag may be determined by the authority of the tag.
  • the authority of the first tag may include usage authority.
  • the so-called usage authority refers to the authority to add the first label to the information unit. Specifically, any user who has the right to use the first label can add the first label to the information unit on the corresponding client terminal.
  • the use authority of the first label may be set by the owner of the first label, and the owner of the first label may designate a user who has the use authority of the first label.
  • the permissions of the first label include viewing permissions.
  • the so-called viewing authority refers to the authority to view the associated information of the first tag. Specifically: on the client terminal of the user who has the viewing authority of the first label, the associated information of the first label is displayed. In other words, the user who has the viewing authority of the first tag can view the associated information of the first tag on the corresponding client terminal.
  • the information unit itself also has viewing rights.
  • the associated information of the first tag displayed on the client of the first user may be the information that the first user has the viewing permission.
  • the associated information of the first tag presented on the client of the first user does not include information that the first user does not have viewing rights. In this way, information security can be effectively protected, and information leakage caused by the first user viewing information for which he does not have viewing rights can be avoided.
  • the first user's client can associate and present the first information unit. label and first information unit. In this way, the first user can determine the specific content of the first information unit according to the first label and the first information unit presented in the association, and determine that the first information unit has the first label .
  • S1202 Display information corresponding to each task in the at least one task on a first page, where the first page is a page displayed on a client that logs in to the account of the first user.
  • the client may display information corresponding to each task in the at least one task on the first page displayed by the client.
  • the first user can view the information of at least one task related to himself on the first page without opening the pages corresponding to each tab, the user operation is simple, and the efficiency of the user viewing tasks related to himself is improved. .
  • a first task in the at least one task is taken as an example.
  • the information of the first task refers to information related to the first task.
  • the information of the first task including but not limited to any one or more of the following:
  • the label of the first task the creator of the first task, the performer of the first task, the due date of the first task, the status of the first task, and the status of the first task Summary information.
  • the status of the first task may include: completed or not completed; the summary information of the first task, for example, may be the subject of the first task, or may be the task description of the first task keywords in .
  • the information corresponding to each task in the aforementioned at least one task may be displayed on the first page in the form of a list.
  • the information of one task may correspond to a record in the list, wherein the content specifically included in the information of each task is indicated by the header of the list.
  • the header of the list includes: tag, creator, performer, due date, status, and summary information.
  • the information of each task in the at least one task includes: the label of each task, the creator of each task, the executor of each task, and the due date of each task , the status of each task, and summary information for each task.
  • the executor of each task may be the user name of the executor of each task, or may be the account avatar of the executor of each task, which is not specifically limited in this embodiment of the application .
  • the creator of each task may be the user name of the creator of each task, or may be the account avatar of the creator of each task, which is not specifically limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the content specifically included in the header of the list may be customized by the first user.
  • the first user may independently select the content specifically included in the information of each task in the at least one task displayed on the first page.
  • the first user may trigger a task information selection operation with respect to the header, and after the first user triggers the task information selection operation, the client may, in response to the task information selection operation, determine the content included in the information of each task displayed on the first page.
  • the header may include by default: label, creator, performer, due date, status, and summary information.
  • the first user may trigger a cancellation operation for one or more of the tag, creator, performer, expiration date, status, and summary information, thereby deleting part of the information from the header.
  • the header of the list no longer includes “Creator” , correspondingly, the creator of each task in the at least one task is no longer displayed on the first page.
  • the information of each task in the at least one task may be sorted in a certain order. Specifically, the arrangement order of the information of each task in the at least one task is: the order of the due date of each task in the at least one task from the nearest to the farthest.
  • the first user may adjust the display positions of some or all of the tasks in the at least one task. Taking the first task as an example, the first user may trigger a position moving operation for the first task, for example, drag the first task to a target position.
  • the client may modify the display position of the first task on the first page in response to the position moving operation.
  • the display position of the first task on the first page is modified, if the user next accesses a page for presenting information about tasks related to the user, the first task on the page displayed by the client.
  • the display position of is the position after the aforementioned modification, so that the user can view the information of the first task intuitively.
  • the first page can be understood with reference to FIG. 13 , which is a schematic diagram of a first page provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the first page displays the information of multiple tasks related to the first user, the information of the multiple tasks is presented in the form of a list, and the information of one task corresponds to a record in the list. And according to the due date of each task in order from nearest to farthest.
  • the header of the list includes: summary information, creator, performer, status, label, and due date.
  • the first user can drag the task corresponding to "Test 3" before the task corresponding to "Test 1" to change the display of the task corresponding to "Test 3" on the first page Location.
  • the target application may also support task filtering functionality. Specifically: the first user may trigger a task screening operation on the first page. After the first user triggers the task screening operation, the client may, in response to the task screening operation, obtain screening conditions of at least one dimension, and determine a task that meets the screening conditions from the at least one task , and further, display the information of the task obtained by filtering.
  • the first page may include a task filter control
  • the client may display a task filter page, and the first user may display a task filter page.
  • a user can edit filter conditions of at least one dimension in the task filter page. Then, the client can obtain the filter condition of the at least one dimension.
  • the at least one dimension mentioned here may be one or more of tags, creators, performers, deadlines, and status.
  • the first user may set the filter condition as: completed, and the executor is user A.
  • the first user may set the filter condition as: not completed, and the due date is before *year*month*day.
  • the first user may set the filter condition as: #A. Not listed here.
  • the first task with the first tag in the at least one task it may be pre-created by the user.
  • a specific implementation manner of creating the first task and adding tags to the first task will be introduced.
  • the user can trigger a task creation operation on a related page of the first tag, thereby creating a first task with the first tag.
  • the task creation operation may be triggered in the overview page of the first tab.
  • the client may create the first task in response to the task creation operation.
  • the client terminal may display a task creation page, and obtain task information input by the user on the task creation page, thereby creating the first task.
  • the user mentioned here may be the aforementioned first user, or may be a second user different from the first user, which is not limited here. It can be understood that, if the user mentioned here is the aforementioned first user, the first user is the creator of the first task.
  • the overview page of the first label is a page for displaying the information of each information field of the first label by region.
  • the various information fields include, but are not limited to, one or more of tasks, cloud documents, messages, schedules, and groups.
  • the overview page of the first label is used to display the information of each information domain that has the first label and that the first user has viewing permission.
  • the overview page may include multiple display areas, and one display area is used to display information of one of the information fields.
  • the information field in this embodiment of the present application is used to provide a certain type of information. Among them, one information domain may correspond to one service provider.
  • the task creation operation may be triggered in the page corresponding to the task information field of the first tab.
  • the client may create the first task in response to the task creation operation.
  • the client terminal may display a task creation page, and acquire task information input by the user on the task creation page, thereby creating the first task.
  • the user mentioned here may be the aforementioned first user, or may be a second user different from the first user, which is not limited here. It can be understood that, if the user mentioned here is the aforementioned first user, the first user is the creator of the first task.
  • the page corresponding to the task information field of the first tag is used to display the information of the task with the first tag. Specifically: on the client of the first user, the page corresponding to the task information field of the first label is used to display the information of the task that has the first label and that the first user has viewing permission.
  • the user can trigger a tag adding operation on the page corresponding to the first task, thereby adding the first tag to the first task.
  • the user mentioned here may be the aforementioned first user, or may be a second user different from the first user, which is not limited here.
  • the client may respond to the tag adding operation and obtain the first tag corresponding to the tag adding operation, The association relationship between the first task and the first label is further saved, so as to achieve the purpose of adding the first label to the first task. specifically:
  • the client terminal may display a character input area in response to the tag adding operation. Then, the user can input characters in the character input area. The user can input at least a part of the characters included in the first label in the character input area.
  • the client can provide the user with corresponding label candidates according to the characters input by the user, and display the label candidates, so that the user can base the label on the label candidates. The candidate selects the first label. After the user selects the first label, that is, the user triggers a selection operation for the first label in the label candidates, for example, clicks the first label, the client can obtain the first label, and further save the association relationship between the first task and the first label.
  • the client may display at least one tag candidate in response to the tag adding operation, and display the at least one tag candidate.
  • the user may trigger a selection operation for one tag candidate in the at least one tag candidate, if the user triggers selection for the first tag in the at least one tag candidate operation, such as clicking on the first label, the client can obtain the first label, and further save the association relationship between the first task and the first label.
  • the user can add the tag to the information only when the user has the usage authority of a certain tag. Therefore, in one example, the at least one tag candidate may be a candidate for which the user has usage rights.
  • the page corresponding to the task information field of the first label is used to display the information of the task with the first label.
  • a task may have labels that may change over time. For example, Task A was originally associated with Project 1 and Project 2, but as the project progresses, Task A is no longer associated with Project 1. At this point, task A is no longer suitable to have a label corresponding to correlation 1 (eg, the first label).
  • the user may trigger the tag cancellation operation on the page corresponding to the task information field of the first tag, and correspondingly, the client may respond to the tag cancellation operation , to delete the association relationship between the first task and the first label.
  • the overview page of the first label no longer presents the information of the first task, and correspondingly, the information of the first label is In the page corresponding to the task information field, the information of the first task is no longer displayed.
  • the first task only has the first label
  • after deleting the association relationship between the first task and the first label if the first page is refreshed, after the refresh
  • the information of the first task is no longer included in the first page of .
  • the first task includes other tags in addition to the first tag, after deleting the association relationship between the first task and the first tag, if the first page is refreshed, the refreshed
  • the first page may include the information of the first task, but only the label of the first task, and no longer includes the first label.
  • FIG. 14 this figure is a schematic flowchart of an information processing method provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the schedule creation method shown in FIG. 14 may include, for example, the following S1401-S1403.
  • S1401 In response to an information addition operation for a first information field triggered by a user, display a first information addition page, where the first information addition page includes identifiers of multiple information fields, and the multiple information fields include the first information addition page. an information field and a second information field.
  • the user may trigger an information addition operation for the first information domain on a page displayed by his client.
  • the page displayed by the client may include a first control, where the first control is used to trigger an information addition operation for the first information field.
  • the user may, for example, click on the first control to trigger an information addition operation for the first information field.
  • the user may trigger an information addition operation for the first information field in the overview page of the first tab.
  • the overview page of the first tab reference may be made to the relevant description part above, and the description will not be repeated here.
  • the client terminal may display a first information addition page in response to the information addition operation.
  • the first information addition page may include identifiers of multiple information fields, and the multiple information fields include at least a first information field and a second information field.
  • the first information domain and the second information domain may be different information domains.
  • the first information field may be one of tasks, cloud documents, messages, schedules, and groups
  • the second information field may also be one of tasks, cloud documents, messages, schedules, and groups.
  • the first information field is a schedule
  • the second information field is a cloud document
  • the first information field is a task
  • the second information field is a cloud document
  • etc. different here A list of instructions.
  • the page corresponding to the information domain is also presented by default.
  • at least one candidate information of the first information domain so that the first user triggers a selection operation on one or more candidate information of the at least one candidate information corresponding to the first information domain, so as to realize adding one or more candidate information
  • the purpose of the information corresponding to the first information field is information that the user has viewing authority.
  • S1402 In response to the user's selection operation triggered by the identifier of the second information domain, display candidate information of the corresponding second information domain, where the second information domain is different from the first information domain.
  • S1403 In response to a selection operation triggered by the user on at least one piece of the candidate information, generate an association relationship between the at least one piece of information and the first tag.
  • the first information addition page includes the identifier of the second information field. If the user wishes to add information corresponding to the second information field, the user can add the information corresponding to the second information field. Identifies the triggering selection action. After the selection operation triggered by the user with respect to the identifier of the second information domain, the client may display a display corresponding to the second information field to the selection operation triggered by the user with respect to the identifier of the second information field. candidate information. It should be noted that, in an example, the candidate information corresponding to the second information field is the information that the user has viewing authority.
  • the user can trigger a selection operation for at least one piece of information in the candidate information of the second information domain, so that the client can respond to the candidate information of the user for the second information domain
  • At least one of the information triggers a selection operation, and a corresponding relationship between the at least one information and the first tag is generated. So far, the purpose of adding at least one piece of information corresponding to the second information field is completed.
  • the page displayed by the client such as the overview page of the first tab, does not need to include the controls for triggering the information addition operation for each information field, but only needs to include the first control.
  • the number of controls included in the page displayed by the client is reduced, so that the layout of the page displayed by the client is more concise.
  • FIG. 15a is a schematic diagram of an overview page of a first label provided by an embodiment of the application
  • FIG. 15b is a schematic diagram of an information addition page provided by an embodiment of the application
  • FIG. 15c is another information provided by an embodiment of the application. Schematic of adding a page.
  • the overview page of the first label "M" includes information of each information field with the first label.
  • the first information field may be a schedule
  • the user may trigger an information addition operation for the schedule through the control "Add Immediately" shown in FIG. 15a.
  • the client can display the information addition page shown in FIG. And the information candidates for the corresponding schedules: Schedule A to Schedule E.
  • the user triggers a selection operation for the identifier of the second information field such as "cloud document”, for example, after the user clicks "cloud document" in Fig. 15b, the client can display the information adding page shown in Fig. 15c.
  • the information addition page shown in FIG. 15c includes information candidates corresponding to cloud documents: cloud document 1 to cloud document 5. If the user triggers a selection operation for the cloud document 1, the client can generate a corresponding relationship between the tag M and the cloud document 1.
  • the client terminal may further display the at least one piece of information on the page corresponding to the second information field of the first tab.
  • the page corresponding to the second information field of the first label is used to present the information having the first label and corresponding to the second information field.
  • the second information field is a cloud document
  • the page corresponding to the second information field of the first tag is used to present the cloud document with the first tag.
  • the page corresponding to the second information field of the first tag is used to present a page with the first tag, corresponding to the second information field, and all The information that the first user has the viewing authority.
  • the user may also trigger an information addition operation for the first information field on the overview page of the first tag, so as to achieve the purpose of adding information corresponding to the first information field with the first tag. specifically:
  • the client may display a second information addition page in response to the information addition operation.
  • the second information adding page may include, for example, an editing area for editing information corresponding to the first information field.
  • the user can edit the information corresponding to the first information field in the editing area on the second information adding page.
  • the user can edit the first information in the editing area in the second information adding page. In this way, the client can obtain the first information, and further generate a corresponding relationship between the first information and the first label.
  • the client may further display the first information on the overview page of the first label.
  • the first information may be displayed in a display area corresponding to the first information field in the overview page.
  • the client may further display the first information on the page corresponding to the first information field of the first label.
  • the page corresponding to the first information field of the first label is used to present the information having the first label and corresponding to the first information field.
  • the user may also trigger a collaborator editing operation on the overview page of the first label to Collaborators make edits.
  • the collaborator of the first label refers to a user who has the viewing permission of the first label. If the user has the right to view the first label, the user has the right to view the associated information of the first label.
  • the associated information of the first tag refers to information of each information field having the first tag.
  • the client may respond to the editing operation of the collaborator, obtain the information of the edited collaborator, and generate the edited The correspondence between collaborators and the first label.
  • the collaborator editing operation mentioned here may include three operations, which are an operation of adding a collaborator, an operation of deleting a collaborator, and an operation of modifying a collaborator.
  • the collaborator add operation is used to add a new collaborator on the basis of the original collaborator
  • the collaborator delete operation is used to delete some or all of the original collaborators
  • the collaborator modification operation is used to modify the original collaborator.
  • the overview page may include a collaborator edit control. After the user triggers the control, the client displays the collaborator edit page, and the user can trigger the collaborator add operation and collaborator delete operation on the collaborator edit page. One or more of an action and a collaborator's modification action.
  • the overview page may include a plurality of controls, respectively adding controls for collaborators, deleting controls for collaborators, and modifying controls for collaborators. A user can trigger a collaborator add operation through the collaborator add control, a user can trigger a collaborator delete operation through the collaborator delete control, and a user can trigger a collaborator modify operation through the collaborator modify control.
  • the overview page of the first label is a page displayed in sub-regions of information of each information domain having the first label.
  • the number of information with the first label in each information field is displayed. It can be understood with reference to FIG. 15a, which shows that the number of tasks corresponding to the task information field is 3, the number of cloud documents corresponding to the cloud document information field is 5, the number of messages corresponding to the message information field is 1, and the number of messages corresponding to the group information field is 1.
  • the number of groups is 1, and the number of schedules corresponding to the schedule information field is 1.
  • the overview page may not be able to completely display the respective information.
  • a preset operation may be triggered for the amount of information corresponding to the first information field, such as clicking on the amount of information corresponding to the first information field.
  • the client can display the page corresponding to the first information field of the first label in response to the preset operation triggered by the user for the amount of information corresponding to the first information field, So that the user can view the specific information of the first information field.
  • the user can trigger a preset operation on the overview page for the second information, such as clicking on the overview page The displayed information summary of the second information, so as to realize the viewing of the second information.
  • the client may respond to the preset operation triggered by the user for the second information in the overview page operation, jump to the page including the second information.
  • the user can view the second information.
  • the client can jump to the page where the group is located.
  • the client can jump to the instant conversation page where the message is located.
  • the second information is a schedule
  • the client can jump to the page where the schedule is located.
  • the client may respond to the preset operation triggered by the user for the second information in the overview page
  • the setting operation is performed to display the second information.
  • the second information mentioned here refers to the information that the user has viewing rights.
  • the second information may be displayed in a browser.
  • the second information may be displayed in a first area (eg, a sidebar) in the overview page.
  • This embodiment of the present application does not specifically limit the second information, and the second information may be any one of tasks, cloud documents, messages, schedules, and groups.
  • the client will display the second information itself in addition to displaying the second information itself.
  • context information of the second information may also be displayed, so that the user can view the second information and the context information of the second information.
  • the second information when the second information is a group, when the second information is displayed in the first area of the overview page in a specific implementation, for example, the summary information (such as the name) of the group may be displayed. . In another example, a real-time conversation interface corresponding to the group may be displayed in the first area.
  • the client displays the instant conversation interface corresponding to the group in the first area of the overview page
  • the user when the user is a user in the group, the user can area to conduct an instant messaging session without jumping to the instant chat interface where the group is located.
  • the user may input an instant conversation message in the first area, and after receiving the instant conversation message input by the user, the client terminal may display the instant conversation message in the instant conversation interface.
  • the client terminal may further display the instant chat messages published by the other users in the first area.
  • the client terminal after a preset operation triggered by the user for the second information in the overview page, the client terminal jumps to a page including the second information. Then, in order to quickly switch the page displayed by the client from the page including the second information to the overview page, the user may also trigger a preset operation in the page including the second information, corresponding to The client may display the overview page in response to a preset operation triggered by the user in the page including the second information. Thus, the page displayed by the client is quickly switched to the overview page.
  • the page including the second information may further include a second control, and the preset operation triggered by the user in the page including the second information may be, for example, clicking on the first Two controls.
  • the apparatus 1600 may specifically include: a first acquisition unit 1601 and a first display unit 1602 .
  • the first obtaining unit 1601 is configured to obtain at least one task that is related to the first user and has a label, where the label is an additional attribute of the at least one task, and the label is at a predetermined level determined by the authority of the label. share within the scope;
  • a first display unit 1602 configured to display information corresponding to each task in the at least one task on a first page, where the first page is: a page displayed on a client that logs in to the account of the first user .
  • the tasks related to the first user include any one or more of the following:
  • the creator is the task of the first user
  • the executor is the task of the first user
  • the at least one task includes a first task
  • the information of the first task includes any one or more of the following:
  • the label of the first task the creator of the first task, the executor of the first task, the due date of the first task, the status of the first task, and the first task summary information.
  • the information corresponding to each task in the at least one task is displayed on the first page in the form of a list, and the information of one task corresponds to a record in the list, and the header of the list uses to indicate what the information for each task includes.
  • the device further includes:
  • a first determining unit configured to determine the content included in the information of each task displayed on the first page in response to the task information selection operation triggered by the first user on the header.
  • the arrangement order of the information of each task in the at least one task is: the order of the due date of each task in the at least one task from near to far.
  • the device further includes:
  • a modification unit configured to modify the display position of the first task in the first page in response to a position movement operation triggered by the first user for the first task of the at least one task.
  • the device further includes:
  • a second obtaining unit configured to obtain at least one dimension filter condition in response to the task screening operation triggered by the first user
  • a second determining unit configured to determine a task that meets the screening condition from the at least one task
  • the second display unit is configured to display the information of the task obtained by screening.
  • the at least one dimension includes:
  • the at least one task includes: a first task with a first tag
  • the device further includes a creation unit for:
  • the first task is created. information; or,
  • the first task is created, and the page corresponding to the task information field is used to display the task with the first tag Information.
  • the at least one task includes: a first task with a first tag, and the device further includes:
  • a third obtaining unit configured to obtain the first label corresponding to the label adding operation in response to the label adding operation triggered by the user on the page corresponding to the first task
  • a saving unit configured to save the association relationship between the first task and the first label.
  • the at least one task includes: a first task with a first tag, and the device further includes:
  • a deletion unit configured to delete the association relationship between the first task and the first tag, and delete the first task in response to a tag cancellation operation triggered by the user in the page corresponding to the task information field of the first tag After the association relationship with the first tag, the overview page of the first tag and the page corresponding to the task information field do not include the first task.
  • the apparatus 600 may specifically include: a first display unit 1701 , a second display unit 1702 and a first generation unit 1703 .
  • the first display unit 1701 is configured to display a first information addition page in response to an information addition operation for the first information field triggered by the user, where the first information addition page includes identifiers of multiple information fields, the The information field includes the first information field and the second information field;
  • the second display unit 1702 is configured to display candidate information corresponding to the second information field in response to the user's selection operation triggered by the identifier of the second information field, the second information field and the first information field different;
  • the first generating unit 1703 is configured to, in response to a selection operation triggered by the user for at least one piece of information in the candidate information, generate an association relationship between the at least one piece of information and the first tag.
  • the information addition operation for the first information domain in response to the user triggering includes:
  • the overview page of the first label is used to display each information domain with the first label in sub-areas Information.
  • candidate information corresponding to the first information field is also presented by default.
  • the device further includes:
  • a third display unit configured to display the at least one piece of information on the page corresponding to the second information field of the first label.
  • the device further includes:
  • the fourth display unit is configured to display a second information adding page in response to an information adding operation for the first information field triggered by the user in the overview page of the first tab, and the overview page of the first tab is used for sorting
  • the area displays the information of each information field with the first label
  • a first obtaining unit configured to obtain the first information corresponding to the first information field added by the user in the second information adding page
  • a second generating unit configured to generate an association relationship between the first information and the first label.
  • the device further includes:
  • a fifth display unit for displaying the first information in the overview page
  • a sixth display unit configured to display the first information on the page corresponding to the first information field of the first label.
  • the device further includes:
  • a second acquiring unit configured to acquire the edited collaborator information in response to the collaborator editing operation triggered by the user on the overview page, and generate a correspondence between the edited collaborator and the first tag relation.
  • the collaborator modifies the operation, including:
  • the overview page of the first label displays the number of information with the first label in each information field, and each information field includes the first information field; the device further includes:
  • a seventh display unit configured to display a page corresponding to the first information field of the first label in response to a preset operation triggered by the user for the amount of information corresponding to the first information field, and the first information field
  • a page corresponding to an information field includes an information summary of the information corresponding to the first information field with the first label.
  • the device further includes:
  • a jumping unit configured to jump to a page including the second information in response to a preset operation triggered by the user for the second information in the overview page of the first tab;
  • an eighth display unit configured to display the second information in response to a preset operation triggered by the user with respect to the second information in the overview page, wherein the user has the viewing authority of the second information;
  • the overview page of the first label is used to display information of each information field with the first label in sub-areas.
  • the second information is an instant communication message
  • the device further includes:
  • a presenting unit configured to present context information of the second information.
  • the device further includes:
  • a ninth display unit configured to display the overview page in response to a preset operation triggered by the user in the page including the second information.
  • the second information is a group
  • the eighth display unit is used for:
  • the instant conversation interface corresponding to the group is displayed in the first area of the overview page.
  • the device further includes:
  • a receiving unit configured to receive an instant conversation message input by the user in the first area, where the user is a user included in the group;
  • a tenth display unit configured to display the instant conversation message in the instant conversation interface.
  • the first information field is any one of the following: tasks, cloud documents, messages, schedules, and groups;
  • the second information field is any one of the following: tasks, cloud documents, messages, schedules, and groups.
  • An embodiment of the present application further provides a device, the device includes a processor and a memory; the processor is configured to execute instructions stored in the memory, so that the device executes the task-based information provided by the above method embodiments Processing or information processing method.
  • Embodiments of the present application further provide a computer-readable storage medium, including instructions, the instructions instructing a device to execute the task-based information processing method or information processing method provided by the above method embodiments.
  • the application embodiments also provide a computer program product, which, when the computer program product runs on a computer, enables the computer to execute the task-based information processing method or the information processing method provided by the above method embodiments.
  • schedules with labels it is necessary to create schedules with labels. For example, for a certain project, for the events related to the project, you can add tags to the events. The participants of the project can locate the schedule related to the project through this label, so that the participants of the project can arrange the work schedule reasonably.
  • the user's operation is relatively cumbersome.
  • project participants associated with the schedule may be given rights to the label, and project participants associated with the schedule may be given access rights to the schedule. In this way, project participants related to the schedule can locate the schedule through the label, so as to arrange the work schedule reasonably.
  • embodiments of the present application provide a method and apparatus for creating a schedule.
  • FIG. 18 is a schematic flowchart of a method for creating a schedule according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • the method provided by this embodiment of the present application may be executed by a client or a server.
  • a target application may be installed on the client, and the server may be the target application the corresponding server.
  • the user mentioned in the embodiments of the present application refers to the user corresponding to the account that logs in the target application program on the client.
  • the method is performed by a client as an example for description.
  • FIG. 19 All the drawings in the embodiments of the present application, such as FIG. 19 , are only shown for the convenience of understanding the contents related to the embodiments of the present application, and do not constitute limitations to the embodiments of the present application.
  • the page shown in FIG. 19 may also include other content, which is not specifically limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the method shown in FIG. 18 may include, for example, the following steps: S1801-S1802.
  • S1801 In response to a schedule adding operation triggered by a user on an associated page of a first label, display a schedule adding page, where the schedule adding page includes the first label, and the associated page of the first label is used to present all the Describe the associated information of the first tag.
  • the associated information of the first tag refers to information that has an associated relationship with the first tag.
  • the information mentioned here includes, but is not limited to, one or more of tasks, schedules, messages, cloud documents, and groups.
  • tasks, schedules, messages, cloud documents, and groups can each correspond to an information domain.
  • tasks can correspond to task information domains
  • schedules can correspond to schedule information domains
  • messages can correspond to message information domains
  • cloud documents can correspond to cloud documents.
  • Information field, a group can correspond to the group information field.
  • the information field in this embodiment of the present application is used to provide a certain type of information.
  • one information domain may correspond to one service provider.
  • the associated page of the first label may be an overview page of the first label, and the overview page of the first label is an overview page for each page with the first label.
  • the overview page of the first tab may include information of each information field having the first tab, for example, including information in the task information field, information in the schedule information field, and information in the message information field , one or more of the information in the cloud document information domain and the information in the group information domain.
  • the information corresponding to each information field is presented in different areas on the overview page.
  • the task information field, the schedule information field, the message information field, the cloud document information field, and the group information field each correspond to a display area, which is used to display information corresponding to itself. That is: the display area corresponding to the task information field is used to display the information of the task with the first tag; the display area corresponding to the schedule information field is used to display the information of the schedule with the first tag; the display area corresponding to the message information field is used to display The information of the message with the first tag; the display area corresponding to the cloud document information field is used to display the information of the cloud document with the first tag; the display area corresponding to the group information field is used to display the information of the group with the first tag .
  • the associated page of the first label may be a page corresponding to the schedule information field of the first label, and the page corresponding to the schedule information field of the first label, Information for displaying the schedule with the first label.
  • the page corresponding to the schedule information field may also be referred to as a "schedule page”.
  • the presented content is the content that the user has viewing permission.
  • the associated page of the first label may include a first control, and a function corresponding to the first control is a function of adding a schedule.
  • the user can trigger a schedule adding operation through the first control. After the user triggers the schedule adding operation, the client terminal may display the schedule adding page, and the first label may be automatically brought into the schedule adding page.
  • the client may, for example, firstly call a calendar application programming interface (Application Programming Interface, API), and pass the first tag as a parameter to the calendar application through the calendar API program, so as to obtain the aforementioned schedule adding page including the first tag.
  • the schedule application is a software module for creating schedules.
  • S1802 Acquire the schedule information input by the user on the schedule adding page, and generate a schedule with the first tag.
  • the user can input schedule information on the schedule adding page, for example, input the subject of the schedule, the start time and end time of the schedule, and detailed information such as the corresponding conference room.
  • the client terminal may acquire the schedule information input by the user, and further generate a schedule with the first tag according to the acquired schedule information. It can be understood that the generated schedule includes schedule information obtained by the client.
  • the schedule page of the first tag may present the summary information of the schedule.
  • the summary information of the schedule mentioned here may be, for example, the topic of the schedule, or may be a keyword in the topic of the schedule, which is not limited here.
  • the schedule page corresponding to the first label is used to display summary information of the schedule with the second label.
  • the schedule page corresponding to the first tab displayed on the client terminal may display summary information of schedules for which the user has viewing rights.
  • multiple tags can be added to an agenda.
  • the user may also trigger a tag editing operation in the schedule adding page.
  • the schedule adding page includes a tag adding control, and the user can trigger the tag editing operation through the tag adding control.
  • the client terminal may obtain the second tag indicated by the tag editing operation.
  • the schedule generated by the client terminal includes the aforementioned first tag, A second tag may also be included.
  • the schedule page of the second tab can present the summary information of the schedule.
  • the schedule page corresponding to the second label is used to display summary information of the schedule with the second label.
  • the schedule page corresponding to the second label displayed on the client terminal may display summary information of schedules for which the user has viewing rights.
  • "acquiring a second tag in response to a tag editing operation triggered by the user on the schedule adding page” may be implemented in various ways. Two possible implementations are described below.
  • the first implementation method :
  • the client may display at least one tag candidate in response to the tag editing operation, and after displaying the at least one tag candidate, the user can One of the tag candidates in the at least one tag candidate triggers a selection operation, and if the user triggers a selection operation for the second tag in the at least one tag candidate, for example, clicks the second tag, then The client can obtain the second tag.
  • the user can add the tag to the information only when the user has the usage authority of a certain tag. Therefore, in one example, the at least one tag candidate may be a candidate for which the user has usage rights.
  • the client terminal may display a character input area in response to the tag editing operation. Then, the user can input characters in the character input area. The user can input at least a part of the characters included in the second label in the character input area.
  • the client can provide the user with corresponding label candidates according to the characters input by the user, and display the label candidates, so that the user can base the label on the label candidates.
  • the candidate selects the second label. After the user selects the second label, that is, the user triggers a selection operation for the second label in the label candidates, for example, after clicking the second label, the client may Get the second label.
  • the schedule generally has corresponding participants.
  • the first label itself may also have a certain identification meaning, for example, related to a certain item.
  • the first label also has certain collaborators, and the so-called collaborators of the first label refer to users who have the authority of the first label. For example, it is a user who has permission to view the first label.
  • the user who has the permission to view the first label has the permission to view the associated information of the first label. Since the schedule has a first label, in some scenarios, the collaborator of the first label may be a default participant of the schedule at the same time.
  • the aforementioned schedule adding page may further include the participants of the schedule, and the participants of the schedule are users who have the permission of the first label.
  • the collaborator of the first tab can be automatically brought into the schedule adding page. In this way, it is not necessary for the user to manually input the participants of the schedule, thereby improving the efficiency of creating the schedule.
  • the participants in the schedule may also be specified by the user.
  • the user can enter the participants of the schedule in the schedule adding page.
  • the participants of the schedule input by the user may include the collaborators of the first label, or may include other users than the collaborators of the first label.
  • the participants in the schedule entered by the user include other users than the collaborator of the first tag
  • the participants in the schedule can be added to the schedule.
  • other users other than the collaborator of the first label become the collaborators of the first label.
  • the client may, in response to the generation of the schedule with the first label, grant the participants of the schedule the permission of the first label.
  • a user who does not originally have the permission of the first label among the participants of the schedule can be given the permission of the first label.
  • the authority of the first label mentioned here may be the viewing authority of the first label.
  • the so-called viewing authority of the first label refers to the authority to view the associated information of the first label, for example, it is used to indicate whether the client used by the user can display the first label in association with at least one device with the first label. access to some information.
  • the related information of the first tag mentioned here refers to the information having the first tag.
  • the participants who entered the schedule by the user include user A and user B, where user B is not the collaborator of the first label, after the schedule is generated, user B can be given the viewing permission of the first label, Make user B a collaborator of the first tag.
  • the user can directly set user B as the participant of the schedule, Flexible operation, simplify user operation and improve user experience.
  • the first label corresponds to a project with multiple people
  • the user B For users who are new to the project.
  • user B can also be quickly set as the participant of the schedule, and the user B can be automatically set as the collaborator of the first label, without additionally setting user B as the collaborator of the first label, Flexible operation and high user experience.
  • FIG. 19 is a schematic diagram of a schedule adding page provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • #A represents the first label
  • " Add Label" adds controls to the label.
  • the participant of the tag may be the collaborator of the first tag, or it may be input by the user, for example, it may be indicated by "***" in the area indicating "participant” in FIG. 19 .
  • For other content in the tag details such as the corresponding conference room, schedule reminder method, etc., for example, it can be represented by "*****" in the area indicating "schedule details” in FIG. 19 .
  • the user After the user inputs the schedule information on the schedule adding page, he can click the "Save” control shown in FIG. 19 to generate the schedule including the first tag.
  • the first tag is not a tag that can only be used locally on the client of the user, but a tag that can be shared within a certain range.
  • the sharing scope of the first tag may be determined by the authority of the first tag.
  • the authority of the first tag may include usage authority.
  • the so-called usage authority refers to the authority to add the first label to the information unit. Specifically, any user who has the right to use the first label can add the first label to the information unit on the corresponding client terminal.
  • the use authority of the first label may be set by the owner of the first label, and the owner of the first label may designate a user who has the use authority of the first label.
  • the permissions of the first label include viewing permissions.
  • the so-called viewing authority refers to the authority to view the associated information of the first tag. Specifically: on the client terminal of the user who has the viewing authority of the first label, the associated information of the first label is displayed. In other words, the user who has the viewing authority of the first tag can view the associated information of the first tag on the corresponding client terminal.
  • the viewing authority of the first label may be set by the owner of the first label, and the owner of the first label may designate a user who has the viewing authority of the first label.
  • the information unit itself also has viewing rights.
  • the associated information of the first tag displayed on the client of the first user may be the information that the first user has the viewing permission.
  • the associated information of the first tag presented on the client of the first user does not include the information that the first user does not have viewing rights. In this way, information security can be effectively protected, and information leakage caused by the first user viewing information for which he does not have viewing rights can be avoided.
  • the first user's client can associate and present the first information unit. label and first information unit. In this way, the first user can determine the specific content of the first information unit according to the first label and the first information unit presented in the association, and determine that the first information unit has the first label .
  • FIG. 20 is a schematic flowchart of another method for creating a schedule provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the schedule creation method shown in FIG. 20 can also be executed by the client or the server. In the following description of the embodiments of the present application, the method is performed by a client as an example for description.
  • the schedule creation method shown in FIG. 20 may include, for example, the following S2001-S2003.
  • S2002 In response to a tag editing operation triggered by the user on the schedule adding page, modify the first tag to a second tag.
  • the user may also have the need to create a schedule with the second label. Therefore, in one example, the user may trigger a schedule adding operation on the associated page of the first tab, and then the client may display the schedule adding page, where the first tab is included in the schedule adding page.
  • the first label is modifiable. Specifically: the user can modify the first label to the second label by triggering the label editing operation.
  • the first implementation method :
  • the client may display at least one tag candidate in response to the tag editing operation, and after displaying the at least one tag candidate, the user can One of the tag candidates in the at least one tag candidate triggers a selection operation, and if the user triggers a selection operation for the second tag in the at least one tag candidate, for example, clicks the second tag, then The client may modify the first label to the second label.
  • the user can add the tag to the information only when the user has the usage authority of a certain tag. Therefore, in one example, the at least one tag candidate may be a candidate for which the user has usage rights.
  • the client terminal may display a character input area in response to the tag editing operation. Then, the user can input characters in the character input area. The user can input at least a part of the characters included in the second label in the character input area.
  • the client can provide the user with corresponding label candidates according to the characters input by the user, and display the label candidates, so that the user can base the label on the label candidates.
  • the candidate selects the second label. After the user selects the second label, that is, the user triggers a selection operation for the second label in the label candidates, for example, clicks the second label, the client may The first label is modified to the second label.
  • S2003 Acquire the schedule information input by the user on the schedule adding page, and generate a schedule with the second label.
  • the user can also enter schedule information in the schedule adding page, for example, enter the subject of the schedule, the start time and end time of the schedule, and the corresponding Details of meeting rooms, etc.
  • the client terminal may acquire the schedule information input by the user, and further generate a schedule with the second tag according to the acquired schedule information. It can be understood that the generated schedule includes schedule information obtained by the client.
  • the schedule page of the second tag may present the summary information of the schedule.
  • an embodiment of the present application further provides a device, which is described below with reference to the accompanying drawings.
  • this figure is a schematic structural diagram of a schedule creation apparatus provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the apparatus 2100 may specifically include: a display unit 2101 , a first acquiring unit 2102 and a generating unit 2103 .
  • the display unit 2101 is configured to display a schedule addition page in response to a schedule addition operation triggered by a user in the associated page of the first label, where the schedule addition page includes the first label and the associated page of the first label, associated information for presenting the first tag;
  • a first obtaining unit 2102 configured to obtain the schedule information input by the user in the schedule adding page
  • the generating unit 2103 is configured to generate a schedule with the first tag.
  • the device further includes:
  • a second obtaining unit configured to obtain the second label indicated by the label editing operation in response to the label editing operation triggered by the user on the schedule adding page;
  • the generating unit 2103 is used for:
  • a schedule including the first tag and the second tag is generated.
  • the user triggers the label editing operation through a label adding control.
  • the second obtaining unit is used for:
  • the second tag is acquired in response to a selection operation triggered by the user for the second tag in the at least one tag candidate.
  • the second obtaining unit is used for:
  • the characters input by the user are acquired, and the second tag is acquired according to the characters input by the user.
  • the device further includes:
  • a first display unit configured to display the summary information of the schedule on the schedule page corresponding to the second label, and the schedule page corresponding to the second label is used to display the summary of the schedule with the second label information.
  • the schedule adding page further includes: participants of the schedule, and the participants of the schedule are users who have viewing rights of the first label.
  • the first obtaining unit 2102 is configured to:
  • the device further includes:
  • a permission setting unit configured to: if before the schedule with the first label is generated, the participants of the schedule input by the user in the schedule adding page do not have the permission of the first label, then In response to the generation of the schedule with the first label, the participants of the schedule are given permission to the first label.
  • the first tag is shared among users who have the authority of the first tag.
  • the authority of the first label includes use authority, and a user who has the authority to use the first label has the authority to add the first label to the information unit on the corresponding client.
  • the authority of the first label includes viewing authority, and the associated information of the first label is displayed on the client terminal of the user who has the viewing authority of the first label.
  • the device further includes:
  • the second display unit is configured to, in response to the first user having the viewing authority of the first label, associate and present the first label and the first information unit on the client of the first user, wherein the The first information unit is an information unit for which the first user has viewing authority.
  • the associated page of the first label includes:
  • the overview page is a page that aggregates and displays the information of each information field with the first label; or, the page corresponding to the schedule information field is used to display the information of the schedule with the first label.
  • the information corresponding to each information field is presented in different areas on the overview page.
  • the apparatus 2100 is an apparatus corresponding to the method corresponding to FIG. 18 provided in the above method embodiments, the specific implementation of each unit of the apparatus 2100 is the same concept as the method shown in FIG. 18 in the above method embodiments Therefore, for the specific implementation of each unit of the apparatus 2100, reference may be made to the relevant description part of the above method embodiments, which will not be repeated here.
  • the figure is a schematic structural diagram of another schedule creation apparatus provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the apparatus 2200 may specifically include: a first display unit 2201 , a modification unit 2202 , an acquisition unit 2203 and a generation unit 2204 .
  • the first display unit 2201 is configured to display a schedule adding page in response to a schedule adding operation triggered by a user in the associated page of the first label, where the schedule adding page includes the first label, the association of the first label a page for presenting the associated information of the first tag;
  • a modification unit 2202 configured to modify the first tag to a second tag in response to a tag editing operation triggered by the user in the schedule adding page;
  • an obtaining unit 2203 configured to obtain the schedule information input by the user in the schedule adding page
  • the generating unit 2204 is configured to generate a schedule with the second label.
  • the modifying unit 2202 is configured to:
  • the first tag is modified to a second tag in response to a selection operation triggered by the user for the second tag in the at least one tag candidate.
  • the modifying unit 2202 is configured to:
  • the device further includes:
  • the second display unit is configured to display the summary information of the schedule on the schedule page corresponding to the second label, and the schedule page corresponding to the second label is used to display the summary of the schedule with the second label information.
  • the apparatus 2200 is an apparatus corresponding to the method corresponding to FIG. 20 provided in the above method embodiment, the specific implementation of each unit of the apparatus 2200 is the same concept as the method shown in FIG. 20 in the above method embodiment Therefore, for the specific implementation of each unit of the apparatus 2200, reference may be made to the relevant description part of the above method embodiments, which will not be repeated here.
  • An embodiment of the present application further provides a device, the device includes a processor and a memory; the processor is configured to execute instructions stored in the memory, so that the device executes the schedule creation method provided by the above method embodiments.
  • Embodiments of the present application further provide a computer-readable storage medium, including instructions, where the instructions instruct a device to execute the schedule creation method provided by the above method embodiments.
  • the application embodiments also provide a computer program product, which, when the computer program product runs on a computer, causes the computer to execute the schedule creation method provided by the above method embodiments.

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Theoretical Computer Science (AREA)
  • General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Software Systems (AREA)
  • Computational Linguistics (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Audiology, Speech & Language Pathology (AREA)
  • Artificial Intelligence (AREA)
  • Human Computer Interaction (AREA)
  • Information Transfer Between Computers (AREA)
  • User Interface Of Digital Computer (AREA)

Abstract

本申请实施例公开了一种信息交互的方法,当用户想要为多个相关联的对象添加标签时,只需对其中一个对象触发标签添加操作即可。降低了用户所需触发的标签添加操作的数量,提高了标签添加的速度,简化了用户操作。本申请实施例提供了一种基于任务的信息处理方法,第一用户可以在第一页面上查看与自身相关的至少一个任务的信息,而无需分别打开各个标签对应的页面,用户操作简单。本申请公开了一种日程创建方法,用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发日程添加操作之后,日程添加页面中会自动带入第一标签,并可以生成包括所述第一标签的日程。无需用户首先创建日程,再为日程添加标签,从而降低了创建具备标签的日程的操作繁琐性。

Description

信息交互/处理方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法及装置
本申请要求以下申请的优先权:
1.于2021年3月25日提交中国国家知识产权局、申请号为202110322529.5、申请名称为“一种信息交互的方法、标签删除方法及装置”的中国专利申请;
2.于2021年3月25日提交中国国家知识产权局、申请号为202110322528.0、申请名称为“一种基于任务的信息处理方法及装置”的中国专利申请;
3.于2021年3月25日提交中国国家知识产权局、申请号为202110321003.5、申请名称为“一种日程创建方法及装置”的中国专利申请;
上述专利申请的全部内容通过引用结合在本申请中。
技术领域
本申请涉及计算机领域,尤其涉及一种信息交互的方法、标签删除方法、信息处理方法、基于日程的信息处理方法、日程创建方法及装置。
背景技术
随着计算机和互联网的技术的发展,各式各样的软件层出不穷。为了满足用户的需求,软件的功能也更加丰富。目前,用户可以通过软件发送文字消息,也可以通过软件将文件上传至云服务器,还可以通过软件设置日程提醒。不论是在工作上还是生活上都为用户带来了很大的方便。
随着用户的使用,软件中的数据会越来越多,不同类型的数据混杂在一起,导致用户难以找到特定类型或具有特定属性的数据。因此,部分现有技术可以为特定的对象添加标签,例如可以为云文档、日程、即时通讯(Instant Messaging,IM)群组、即时通讯消息等对象添加标签。这样,用户通过标签较为快速地找到目标对象。
但是,目前用户在创建针对具备标签对象,或者针对具备标签的对象执行相应的操作时,操作繁琐,因此,急需一种方案,能够解决上述问题。
发明内容
为了解决现有技术的问题,本申请实施例提供了一种信息交互的方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法、基于日程的信息处理方法及装置。
第一方面,本申请实施例提供了一种信息交互的方法,所述方法包括:
接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作;
根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
第二方面,本申请实施例提供了一种标签删除方法,所述方法包括:
接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作;
根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
第三方面,本申请实施例提供了一种信息交互的装置,包括:
接收模块,用于接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作;
第一生成模块,用于根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
第二生成模块,用于响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
第四方面,本申请实施例提供了一种标签删除装置,包括:
接收模块,用于接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作;
第一删除模块,用于根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
第二删除模块,用于响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
第五方面,本申请实施例提供了一种基于任务的信息处理方法,所述方法包括:
获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务,所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享;
在第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,所述第一页面为:登录所述第一用户的账户的客户端上显示的页面。
第六方面,本申请实施例提供了一种信息处理方法,所述方法包括:
响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域;
响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应第二信息域的候选信息,所述第二信息域与所述第一信息域不同;
响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
第七方面,本申请实施例提供了一种基于任务的信息处理装置,所述装置包括:
第一获取单元,用于获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务,所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享;
第一显示单元,用于在第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,所述第一页面为:登录所述第一用户的账户的客户端上显示的页面。
第八方面,本申请实施例提供了一种信息处理装置,所述装置包括:
第一显示单元,用于响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域;
第二显示单元,用于响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应第二信息域的候选信息,所述第二信息域与所述第一信息域不同;
第一生成单元,用于响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
第九方面,本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建方法,所述方法包括:
响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用 于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,生成具备所述第一标签的日程。
第十方面,本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建方法,所述方法包括:
响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签;
获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,生成具备所述第二标签的日程。
第十一方面,本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建装置,所述装置包括:
显示单元,用于响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
第一获取单元,用于获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息;
生成单元,用于生成具备所述第一标签的日程。
第十二面,本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建装置,所述装置包括:
第一显示单元,用于响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
修改单元,用于响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签;
获取单元,用于获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息;
生成单元,用于生成具备所述第二标签的日程。
第十三方面,本申请实施例提供了一种设备,所述设备包括处理器和存储器;
所述处理器用于执行所述存储器中存储的指令,以使得所述设备执行以上第一方面任一项或者以上第二方面任一项或者第五方面任一项或者第六方面任一项或者第九方面任一项或者第十方面任一项所述的方法。
第十四方面,本申请实施例提供了一种计算机可读存储介质,包括指令,所述指令指示设备执行以上第一方面任一项或者以上第二方面任一项或者第五方面任一项或者第六方面任一项或者第九方面任一项或者第十方面任一项所述的方法。
第十五方面,本申请实施例提供了一种计算机程序产品,当所述计算机程序产品在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行以上第一方面任一项或者以上第二方面任一项或者第五方面任一项或者第六方面任一项或者第九方面任一项或者第十方面任一项所述的方法。
在本申请实施例提供的信息交互的方法中,可以根据用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,并响应于第一对应关系的生成自动生成第二对应关系。也就是说,可以为第一对象添加标签,并基于“为第一对象添加标签”这一行为自动为第二对象添加标签。这样,可以根据用户对单个对象触发的标签添加操作自动为与该对象关联的其他对象添加相同的标签,无需分别针对每个对象添加标签添加操作。那么,当用户想要为多个相关联的对象添加标签时,只需对其中一个对象触发标签添加操作即可。如此,降低了用户所需触发的标签添加操作的数量,提高了标签添加的速度,让用户能够得到更好的体验。
本申请实施例提供了一种基于任务的信息处理方法。在一个示例中,客户端可以获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务。所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签可以在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享。获取所述至少一个任务之后,可以在所述客户端显示的第一页面上呈现所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息。由此可见,利用本方案,第一用户可以在第一页面上查看与自身相关的至少一个任务的信息,而无需分别打开各个标签对应的页面,用户操作简单,也提升了用户查看与自身相关的任务的效率。
本申请实施例提供了一种信息处理方法。在一个示例中,用户可以触发针对第一信息域的信息添加操作。用户触发所述信息添加操作之后,客户端可以响应该操作,显示第一信息添加页面。其中,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域。此时,用户可以针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,客户端可以响应于用户 针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应第二信息域的候选信息。此处提及的第二信息域与第一信息域不同。进一步地,所述用户可以针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,客户端可以响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。由此可见,利用本方案,即使用户在第一标签的概览页面中触发了针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,也可以添加具备第一标签的、第二信息域的信息。
本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建方法。用户可以在客户端显示的第一标签的关联页面中触发日程添加操作,客户端可以响应于该日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,该日程添加页面中包括第一标签。其中,第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息。显示日程添加页面之后,用户可以在该日程添加页面中输入日程信息,客户端则可以获取所述日程信息,并进一步基于所述日程信息生成具备所述第一标签的日程。由此可见,利用本方案,用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发日程添加操作之后,日程添加页面中会自动带入第一标签,进一步地,可以生成包括所述第一标签的日程。无需用户首先创建日程,再为日程添加标签,从而降低了创建具备标签的日程的操作繁琐性。
本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建方法。用户可以在客户端显示的第一标签的关联页面中触发日程添加操作,客户端可以响应于该日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,该日程添加页面中包括第一标签。其中,第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息。显示日程添加页面之后,用户可以在该日程添加页面中触发标签编辑操作,将该日程添加页面中的第一标签修改为第二标签。而后,用户可以在该日程添加页面中输入日程信息,客户端则可以获取所述日程信息,并进一步基于所述日程信息生成具备所述第二标签的日程。由此可见,利用本方案,用户希望创建具备第二标签的日程时,即使客户端显示的页面为第一标签的关联页面,用户也无需将客户端显示的页面切换为第二标签的关联页面,用户在第一标签的关联页面中即可创建具备第二标签的日程,从而提升了创建具备标签的日程的操作灵活性。
附图说明
为了更清楚地说明本申请实施例或现有技术中的技术方案,下面将对实施例或现有技术描述中所需要使用的附图作简单地介绍,显而易见地, 下面描述中的附图仅仅是本申请中记载的一些实施例,对于本领域普通技术人员来讲,在不付出创造性劳动的前提下,还可以根据这些附图获得其它的附图。
图1为本申请提供的一种信息交互的方法的流程示意图;
图2为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的一种示意图;
图3为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的另一种示意图;
图4为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的又一种示意图;
图5为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的又一种示意图;
图6-a为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的又一种示意图;
图6-b为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的又一种示意图;
图6-c为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的又一种示意图;
图6-d为本申请实施例提供的客户端的显示界面的又一种示意图;
图7为本申请提供的一种标签删除方法的流程示意图;
图8为本申请提供的另一种标签删除方法的流程示意图;
图9为本申请实施例提供的信息交互的装置的一种结构示意图;
图10为本申请实施例提供的标签删除装置的一种结构示意图;
图11为本申请实施例提供的电子设备的一种结构示意图。
图12为本申请实施例提供的一种基于任务的信息处理方法的流程示意图;
图13为本申请实施例提供的一种第一页面的示意图;
图14为本申请实施例提供的一种信息处理方法的流程示意图;
图15a为本申请实施例提供的一种第一标签的概览页面的示意图;
图15b为本申请实施例提供的一种信息添加页面的示意图;
图15c为本申请实施例提供的又一种信息添加页面的示意图。
图16为本申请实施例提供的一种基于任务的信息处理装置的结构示意图;
图17为本申请实施例提供的一种信息处理装置的结构示意图。
图18为本申请实施例提供的一种日程创建方法的流程示意图;
图19为本申请实施例提供的一种日程添加页面的示意图;
图20为本申请实施例提供的又一种日程创建方法的流程示意图;
图21为本申请实施例提供的一种日程创建装置的结构示意图;
图22为本申请实施例提供的又一种日程创建装置的结构示意图。
具体实施方式
下面将参照附图更详细地描述本申请的实施例。虽然附图中显示了本申请的某些实施例,然而应当理解的是,本申请可以通过各种形式来实现,而且不应该被解释为限于这里阐述的实施例,相反提供这些实施例是为了更加透彻和完整地理解本申请。应当理解的是,本申请的附图及实施例仅用于示例性作用,并非用于限制本申请的保护范围。
应当理解,本申请的方法实施方式中记载的各个步骤可以按照不同的顺序执行,和/或并行执行。此外,方法实施方式可以包括附加的步骤和/或省略执行示出的步骤。本申请的范围在此方面不受限制。
本文使用的术语“包括”及其变形是开放性包括,即“包括但不限于”。术语“基于”是“至少部分地基于”。术语“一个实施例”表示“至少一个实施例”;术语“另一实施例”表示“至少一个另外的实施例”;术语“一些实施例”表示“至少一些实施例”。其他术语的相关定义将在下文描述中给出。
需要注意,本申请中提及的“第一”、“第二”等概念仅用于对不同的对象、装置、模块或单元进行区分,并非用于限定这些装置、模块或单元所执行的功能的顺序或者相互依存关系。
需要注意,本申请中提及的“一个”、“多个”的修饰是示意性而非限制性的,本领域技术人员应当理解,除非在上下文另有明确指出,否则应该理解为“一个或多个”。
目前,为了便于管理和查找,部分软件具有标签添加的功能。用户可以通过标签添加操作为消息、云文档等对象添加标签。这样,用户可以通过标签查找消息或云文档等对象。
在添加标签时,用户可以对待添加标签的目标对象触发标签添加操作,例如可以通过点击该目标对象对应的标签添加控件触发标签添加操作。客户端在接收到用户触发的标签添加操作之后,可以根据该标签添加操作确定目标标签,并生成目标对象和目标标签之间的对应关系,从而为目标对象添加目标标签。这样,可以基于标签添加操作为目标对象添加标签,使得用户可以对目标对象进行了灵活管理。但是,现有的标签添加方法需要 针对每个目标对象触发一次标签添加操作。当待添加标签的目标对象的数量较多时,用户需要分别针对每个目标对象触发一次标签添加操作。显然,这大大增加了用户的操作量,不但降低了标签添加的速度。
另外,在删除目标对象的目标标签时,用户一次也只能触发对一个目标对象的标签删除操作。当需要删除多个目标对象的目标标签时,需要用户对多个目标对象中每个目标对象触发标签删除操作。虽然用户也可以,直接删除目标标签,但是这样会删除所有具有目标标签的全部目标对象的目标标签删除,无法删除部分具有目标标签的目标对象的目标标签。
为了解决现有技术的问题,本申请实施例提供了一种信息交互的方法和标签删除方法,下面结合说明书附图进行详细介绍。
图1为本申请实施例提供的一种信息交互的方法的流程示意图,本实施例可适用于对相关联的第一对象和第二对象添加标签的场景,该方法可以由添加标签的处理装置来执行,该装置可以由软件和/或硬件的方式来实现,集成于用户的客户端。其中,客户端可以集成于PC(Personal Computer,个人计算机)端或者移动终端中。当然,本申请实施例提供的信息交互的方法(包括后文所述的标签删除方法)还可以由服务器等计算机设备执行。下面以该方法由客户端来执行为例进行说明。如图1所示,该方法具体包括以下步骤:
S101:接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作。
在本申请实施例中,第一对象可以是云文件、本地文件、文件夹、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组等对象中的任意一种,即用户可以对上述各个对象触发标签添加操作。下文所述的第二对象可以是云文件、本地文件、文件夹、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组等对象中任意一种与第一对象相关联的对象。其中,云文件可以是存储在服务器的文件,例如可以是云文档,即存储在服务器的文档文件,也可以是云视频,即存储在服务器的视频文件。用户可以从服务器中下载该云文件到本地,或者,也可以通过访问该云文件在服务器存储的存储地址来打开(例如,在网页浏览器中打开)云文件。本地文件是存储在客户端本地的文件。同理,文件夹可以是云文件的文件夹,也可以是本地文件的文件夹。
即时通讯消息是用户通过即时通讯软件发送或接收到的消息。即时通 讯消息包括群聊即时通讯消息和单聊即时通讯消息。其中,群聊即时通讯消息是即时通讯用户在即时通讯群组中发送的消息,单聊即时通讯消息是一个即时通讯用户通过单聊发送给另一个即时通讯用户的消息。即时通讯群组包括至少三名即时通讯用户,在即时通讯群组中发送的消息可以被该群组中任意一名即时通讯用户看到。单聊是指两个即时通讯用户之间发送的消息,该消息不能被第三名即时通讯用户看到。
在本申请实施例中,标签添加操作可以是滑动操作,也可以是对标签添加控件触发的操作,例如可以是点击标签添加控件等操作。其中,滑动操作是指客户端获取到的由用户触发的在屏幕上的滑动轨迹。当客户端的屏幕为非触摸屏时,滑动操作可以是用户通过外设(例如,鼠标、手写板等)控制光标或鼠标在屏幕上移动产生滑动轨迹的操作;当客户端的屏幕为触摸屏时,滑动操作可以是用户在屏幕上移动手指产生滑动轨迹的操作。
当滑动轨迹为预设轨迹时,可以确定用户触发了标签添加操作。例如,假设客户端的屏幕为触摸屏且所述预设轨迹为圆形,客户端可以记录用户手指的滑动轨迹。如果检测到滑动轨迹为圆形,可以确定用户触发了标签添加操作。
标签添加控件为用于触发标签添加操作的控件。当用户触发标签添加控件时,例如点击或长按标签添加控件时,客户端可以确定用户触发了标签添加操作。用户可以在展示第一对象的界面对第一对象触发标签添加操作,也可以在展示标签的标签显示界面中对第一对象触发标签添加操作。关于标签显示界面的详细介绍可以参见下文,这里不再赘述。
S102:根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系。
在接收到用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作后,可以根据该标签添加操作生成第一对应关系。第一对应关系为第一对象和目标标签之间的对应关系。其中,目标标签为用户想要为第一对象添加的标签。
在本申请实施例中,第一对象可以是文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组等能够添加标签的操作对象中的任意一种。相应地,后文所述的第二对象可以是上述对象中任意一种与第一对象相关联的对象。
在生成第一对应关系前,可以先根据标签添加操作确定目标标签。在 本申请实施例中,目标标签可以是触发标签添加操作的用户创建的,也可以是不同于该用户的其他用户创建的。在获取目标标签前,可以判断用户是否具有为第一对象添加目标标签的权限。例如,假设用户A创建了标签X,且用户B具有添加标签X的权限。那么,当用户B想要为第一对象添加标签X时,可以确定用户B具有添加标签X的权限,从而为第一对象添加标签X。
为了获取目标标签,可以呈现多个可以添加的候选标签。那么在触发标签添加操作之后,用户可以对期望添加的目标标签进行选中操作,即从候选标签中选择一个或多个标签作为目标标签。相应的,可以在接收用户触发的标签添加操作后接收用户触发的选中操作,从而根据用户的需求确定目标标签,以便为第一对象添加目标标签。在本申请实施例中,显示的至少一个候选标签可以按照预设规则进行排列。该预设规则可以包括标签创建时间、标签访问时间以及与关键词之间的匹配度中的任意一种或多种。候选标签可以包括用户创建的标签,也可以包括其他用户创建的标签,关键词可以是用户在标签搜索框中输入的关键词。
在根据标签添加操作确定目标标签后,可以生成第一对象和目标标签之间的对应关系,为第一对象添加目标标签。
在一些可能的实现中,第一对应关系还可以包括目标标签和第一对象的信息块(Block)之间的对应关系。同理,第二对应关系也可以包括目标标签和第二对象的信息块之间的对应关系。其中,信息块是基于对象(例如第一对象或第二对象)生成的。具体的,第一对象的信息块可以包括第一对象的摘要信息,用于简要描述该第一对象;第二对象的信息块可以包括第二对象的摘要信息,用于简要描述该第二对象。例如,当第二对象为云文件中的云文档时,第二对象的信息块可以包括云文档的摘要信息,该云文档的摘要信息可以包括云文档的标题、作者、发布时间等信息;当第二对象为即时通讯消息时,第二对象的摘要信息可以是即时通讯消息的发送者和即时通讯消息的前n个字,n为大于或等于1的整数。
信息块还可以包括对象(例如第一对象或第二对象)的展示信息,该展示信息用于展示该对象。例如,当第一对象为云文档时,第一对象的展示信息可以包括云文档的链接,通过该链接可以显示该云文档的全部内容; 当第一对象为即时通讯消息时,第一对象的展示信息可以包括与目标标签对应的即时通讯消息的全部内容(不打开即时通讯软件窗口),或者包括该即时通讯消息的调用链,通过该调用链可以在即时通讯软件窗口内显示与目标标签对应的技术通讯消息的全部内容。
与第一对应关系类似,后文所述第二对应关系也可以包括目标标签和第二对象的信息块之间的对应关系。
S103:响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成和第二对应关系。
在确定生成第一对应关系后,可以根据第一对应关系的生成或前述用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作生成第二对应关系。其中,第二对应关系为第二对象和目标标签之间的对应关系。第二对象为与第一对象相关联的对象。也就是说,在接收到用于为第一对象添加目标标签的标签添加操作后,可以根据该标签添加操作自动为与该第一对象相关联的第二对象添加目标标签。
下面首先对第二对象进行详细介绍。
第二对象是与第一对象相关联的对象,例如可以是属于第一对象的其他对象,或在第一对象的基础上生成的其他对象。举例说明:假设第一对象为文件夹,那么第二对象可以是该文件夹中的子文件夹或者文件。即第二对象为属于第一对象的其他对象。假设第一对象为即时通讯群组,那么第二对象可以是用户在该即时通讯群组中发送的消息(例如即时通讯群组中被群成员以某种方式关注的消息)或文件。即第二对象为在第一对象的基础上生成的其他对象。
在本申请实施例中,第二对象可以是客户端或服务器在接收到标签添加操作之前获取的历史关联对象,也可以是客户端或服务器在接收到标签添加操作之后获取的新对象。下面分别对这两种情况进行介绍。
在第一种可能的实现中,第二对象是客户端或服务器在接收到前述用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作之前获取的历史关联对象,即客户端或服务器先获取第二对象,再接收标签添加操作。那么,在获取到第二对象后,可以记录第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系。在接收到用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作后,可以查找已存储的关联关系,从而确定与第一对象相关联的第二对象,再生成第二对象与目标标签之间的第二对应关 系,为第二对象添加标签。
以第一对象为即时通讯群组A,第二对象为群聊即时通讯消息B为例进行说明。在通过即时通讯群组A接收到群聊即时通讯消息B后,客户端可以记录该群聊即时通讯消息B和即时通讯群组A之间的关联关系。那么,在接收到用户对即时通讯群组A触发的标签添加操作之后,客户端可以根据记录的关联关系查找与即时通讯群组A相关联的群聊即时通讯消息B,并生成目标标签和群聊即时通讯消息B之间的对应关系,为群聊即时通讯消息B添加目标标签,无需用户手动地为群聊即时通讯消息B添加该目标标签。
在第二种可能的实现中,第二对象是客户端或服务器在接收到标签添加操作之后获取的新关联对象,即客户端或服务器先接收标签添加操作,再获取第二对象。那么,在接收到标签添加操作后,可以记录该标签添加操作,并在获取到第二对象之后根据记录的标签添加操作生成第二对象与目标标签之间的对应关系,为第二对象添加标签。
同样以第一对象为即时通讯群组A,第二对象为群聊即时通讯消息B为例进行说明。在接收到用户对即时通讯群组A触发的标签添加操作后,客户端可以记录该标签添加操作。接着,如果又通过该即时通讯群组A接收到了新的群聊即时通讯消息B,客户端可以确定群聊即时通讯消息B与即时通讯群组A相关联,从而根据已记录的标签添加操作生成群聊即时通讯消息B和目标标签之间的第二对应关系,为群聊即时通讯消息B添加目标标签。
在生成第二对应关系前,客户端或服务器可以先确定用户已经触发开启标签自动添加功能。其中,标签自动添加功能被开启表示用户允许客户端或服务器根据对第一对象的标签添加操作为第二对象添加标签。也就是说,当标签自动添加功能被开启时,可以根据标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,并基于第一对应关系的生成自动为第二对象添加目标标签。当标签自动添加功能被关闭时,可以仅根据标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,并不基于第一对应关系生成第二对应关系。
在一些可能的实现方式中,用户可以对操作控件的触发操作控制标签自动添加功能的开启或关闭。例如,客户端可以向用户展示第一控件,该 第一控件用于控制标签自动添加功能的开启或关闭。如果检测到用户触发了第一控件,可以开启(或关闭)标签自动添加功能。
根据前文介绍可知,目标标签可以是触发标签添加操作的用户创建的,也可以是不同于该用户的其他用户创建的。那么在生成第二对应关系前,还可以判断该触发标签添加操作的用户是否具有第二对象的标签添加权限。若用户具有第二对象的标签添加权限,可以生成第二对应关系。若用户不具有第二对象的标签添加权限,即使第一对象与第二对象为关联对象,且第一对象已被执行了标签添加操作,仍然不会自动地为第二对象添加目标标签。
另外,在一些可能的实现方式中,可以在生成第二对应关系之前判断第一对象所指示的用户集合是否具有为第二对象添加标签的能力。例如,客户端可以判断第一对象所指示的用户集合是否具有第二对象的访问权限。如果第一对象所指示的用户集合不具有第二对象的访问权限,说明第一对象对应的用户集合可能无法查看或编辑第二对象,那么客户端可以不生成第二对应关系。相反的,如果第一对象所指示的用户集合具有第二用户的访问权限。客户端可以生成第二对应关系。需要说明的是,第一对象所指示的用户集合为一个整体。也就是说,即使第一对象所指示的用户集合中一个或多个用户具有第二对象的访问权限,第一对象所指示的用户集合可能仍不具有第二对象的访问权限。
举例说明。假设第一对象为即时通讯群组,第二对象为发送到该即时通信群组中的云文件。那么在为即时通信群组添加目标标签之后,在为云文件添加目标标签之前,可以判断该即时通信群组对应的用户集合是否具有云文件的访问权限。如果即时通讯群群组对应的用户集合具有云文件的访问权限,可以生成云文件和目标标签之间的对应关系,为云文件添加目标标签。
在本申请实施例中,第一对应关系和第二对应关系是客户端或服务器根据对第一对象触发的标签添加操作自动生成的,即第一对象的目标标签是用户手动添加的,第二对象的目标标签是自动添加的。那么,为了区分自动添加的标签和手动添加的标签,可以将第二对应关系中的目标标签的标签类型设置为自动添加类型,表示第二对象的目标标签是自动添加的, 并非根据针对第二对象的标签添加操作添加的。关于标签类型的具体作用可以参见后文后文图7所示实施例的介绍,这里不再赘述。
在生成第二对应关系后,如果接收到了用于为第二对象添加目标标签的标签添加操作,由于第二对象和目标标签之间的对应关系已经生成,可以不生成新的对应关系,并将第二对应关系中目标标签的标签类型修改为手动添加类型。
在生成第二对应关系之后,客户端可以显示提示信息,该提示信息用于指示完成对第一对象和第二对象添加目标标签。用户在看到提示消息后,可以知晓已经为第一对象和第二对象添加了目标标签。可选的,提示消息可以是图标,也可以是通知消息。
在本申请实施例中,当第一对应关系或第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系被解除后,客户端可以相应地解除第二对应关系。关于这部分内容的详细描述可以参见后文图7所示实施例的介绍,这里不再赘述。
在本申请实施例提供的信息交互的方法中,可以根据用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,并响应于第一对应关系的生成自动生成第二对应关系。也就是说,可以为第一对象添加标签,并基于“为第一对象添加标签”这一行为自动为第二对象添加标签。这样,可以根据用户对单个对象触发的标签添加操作自动为与该对象关联的其他对象添加相同的标签,无需分别针对每个对象添加标签添加操作。那么,当用户想要为多个相关联的对象添加标签时,只需对其中一个对象触发标签添加操作即可。如此,降低了用户所需触发的标签添加操作的数量,提高了标签添加的速度,让用户能够得到更好的体验。
在本申请实施例中,第一对象和第二对象可以是由多个用户协作处理的项目中的对象。例如,假设用户A、用户B和用户C协作处理项目X,并为该项目X创建了即时通讯群组Y,在即时通讯群组Y中发送了云文件Z。那么,当用户A、用户B或用户C中任意一名用户为即时通讯群组Y添加了目标标签M后,客户端或服务器可以生成即时通讯群组Y与目标标签M之间的对应关系,并基于该对应关系的生成自动为云文件Z也添加目标标签M。那么即时通讯群组Y中的其他用户既可以看到即时通讯群组Y具有目标标签M,也可以看到云文件具有目标标签M。这样,在进行项目 协作时,可以基于用户对一个对象触发的标签添加操作自动为该项目中其余一个或多个相关联的对象自动添加标签。
另外,第一对象和第二对象可以是文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组中的任意一种。也就是说,用户可以为不同标签域的对象添加相同的标签,且可以查看属于该标签的不同标签域的对象。如此,实现了标签的跨标签域分配,提高了管理的灵活程度。关于标签域的其他介绍可以参见后文,这里不再赘述。
进一步地,本申请实施例中第一对应关系和/或第二对应关系还可以包括标签和信息块之间的对应关系。这样,相较于传统的收藏方法,还可以根据标签和对象的信息块向用户展示对象的摘要信息等信息。如此,增加了用户能够看到的信息量,使得用户能够更快的找到所需的对象。
也就是说,在本申请实施例中,可以将属于不同标签域的不同对象提取为信息块,并生成信息块与标签的对应关系。这样,将不同标签域的对象提取为信息块可以解决异构信息实体,在跨业务应用跨业务域流通时的同质化建模和打标签的一致性,支持跨业务信息聚合和二次消费的场景。也即是说,信息块化就是对来自不同标签域的对象(即异构信息实体)进行了统一的封装,使得在打标操作时,不用关心不同域的内容的不同结构,统一打标所需操作。如果不做封装,不同域的异构实体,如果没有同质化的解法,就需要比较高的集成成本。
在生成第二对应关系(或第一对应关系)后,用户可以通过对第二对象的标签进行操作。例如,用户可以对第二对象触发标签删除操作,以控制客户端或服务器删除第二对应关系。用户还可以对第二对象触发标签编辑操作。在接收到标签编辑操作后,可以根据标签编辑操作对第二对应关系中的目标对象进行修改。另外,用户还可以对第二对象触发标签添加操作。可以根据用户对第二对象触发的标签添加操作确定新的目标标签并生成第三对应关系,该第三对应关系为所述新的目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系。
下面以第一对象为即时通讯群组“工作交流群”、第二对象为云文件A,且上述过程由客户端执行为例,对上述过程进行介绍。
当用户在客户端上查看群聊即时通讯消息时,客户端可以显示群聊即时通讯消息和该即时通讯群组的相关信息。具体的,如图2所示,当客户端显示群聊即时通讯消息时,显示区域内可以包括标题显示区域210、消息显示区域220和操作区域230。其中,标题显示区域210用于显示即时通讯群组的基本信息。例如在图2所示实施例中,标题显示区域210显示了即时通讯群组的群名称“工作交流群”和群头像。可选的,标题显示区域210还可以包括跳转控件211,用于控制客户端跳转到其他界面,例如可以用于跳转至显示标签添加控件的界面,即图3所示的界面。
消息显示区域220可以用于显示群聊即时通讯消息。可选的,客户端在显示群聊即时通讯消息时可以将消息正文和对应的用户信息一同显示。例如在图2所示实施例中,群聊即时通讯消息221包括头像显示区域221-1、标识显示区域221-2和正文显示区域221-3。其中,头像显示区域221-1用于显示发送该群聊即时通讯消息的用户的头像;标识显示区域221-2用于显示发送该群聊即时通讯消息的用户的标识,例如可以是用户的ID或昵称。正文显示区域221-3用于显示该用户发布的群聊即时通讯消息的正文,在图2所示实施例中,群聊即时通讯消息221的正文为“大家注意一下”。
操作区域230可以包括输入框231和发送控件232。输入框231用于输入群聊即时通讯消息,发送控件232用于发送输入框231中待发送的群聊即时通讯消息。
当第一对象为即时通讯群组时,用户可以通过标签添加控件触发对第一对象的标签添加操作。可选地,客户端可以在即时通讯群组的界面(例如显示群聊即时通讯消息的界面)中显示标签添加控件,也可以基于用户触发的跳转操作跳转到其他界面,并在该界面展示标签添加控件。在图2所示的实施例中,即时通讯聊天群组的聊天界面中并不包括用于为群组添加标签的标签添加控件,用户可以点击跳转控件211控制客户端显示即时通讯群组的设置界面,该设置界面包括标签添加控件,用于触发标签添加操作。
如图3所示,在显示即时通讯群组的设置界面时,客户端的显示区域中可以包括标题显示区域310、位置调整控件320、头像调整控件330、名称调整控件340和标签添加控件350。
其中,标题显示区域310用于显示设置界面的基本信息和基本的操作控件。例如图3所示实施例中标题显示区域310显示了设置界面的名称为“设置-工作交流群”,表示该设置界面用于设置群组名称为“工作交流群”的即时通讯群组的相关信息。
位置调整控件320用于调整当前所在界面与显示区域300的相对位置。如图3所示,位置调整控件320包括滑槽321和滑块控件322。滑块控件322能够在滑槽321中上下移动,从而调整调整设置界面与显示区域300的相对位置。
头像调整控件330可以用于显示即时通讯群组的头像,也可以用于调整即时通讯群组的头像。例如,当用户想要修改“工作交流群”这一即时通讯群组的群头像时,用户可以点击客户端屏幕上头像调整控件330对应的位置,从而触发头像更换操作,调整即时通讯群组的群头像。
名称调整控件340可以用于显示即时通讯群组的群组名称,也可以用于调整即时通讯群组的名称。如图3所示,名称调整控件340包括标注信息341、名称显示区域342和编辑控件343。其中,标注信息341用于提示用户名称显示区域342显示的内容为该即时通讯群组的名称,名称显示区域342用于显示即时通讯群组的名称,编辑控件343用于触发名称变更操作。例如,当用户想要修改“工作交流群”这一即时通讯群组的群名称时,用户可以点击客户端屏幕上名称调整控件340中编辑控件343从而触发名称变更操作,调整即时通讯群组的群名称。
标签添加控件350可以用于为即时通讯群组添加标签,也可以用于显示即时通讯群组对应的标签,还可以用于调整即时通讯群组对应的标签。如图3所示,标签添加控件350包括标注信息351,标签显示区域352和标签添加控件353。其中,标注信息351用于提示用户标签显示区域352显示的内容为该即时通讯群组对应的标签。标签显示区域352用于显示即时通讯群组对应的标签。可选的,当即时通讯群组没有标签时,标签显示区域342可以显示“暂无标签”。标签添加控件353可以用于触发标签添加操作。可选的,当即时通讯群组具有标签时,标签添加控件353还可用于触发标签删除操作或标签变更操作。
在一些可能的实现中,标签添加控件353可以包括指示消息,用于提 示用户标签添加控件353可以用于触发标签添加操作,或提示标签添加控件353可以用于触发标签删除操作或标签变更操作。例如,当即时通讯群组没有标签时,标签添加控件353的指示消息可以为“添加”,用于提示用户标签添加控件353可以用于触发标签添加操作;当即时通讯群组具有标签时,标签添加控件353的指示消息可以为“添加”,用于提示用户标签添加控件353可以用于触发标签添加操作、标签变更操作或标签删除操作。
当用户想要为即时通讯群组“工作交流群”添加目标标签时,可以通过触发标签添加控件353向客户端发送针对即时通讯群组“工作交流群”触发的标签添加操作。在接收到用户触发的标签添加操作后,客户端可以生成即时通讯群组“工作交流群”和目标标签之间的对应关系,即第一对应关系。
在生成第一对应关系后,客户端可以判断即时通讯群组“工作交流群”是否存在相关联的对象。如果用户在“工作交流群”中分享了云文件A,客户端可以确定云文件A与即时通讯群组“工作交流群”相关联。那么,客户端可以判断触发标签添加操作的用户(例如当前登录客户端的用户)是否具有云文件A的标签添加权限,若具有,客户端可以生成云文件A与目标标签之间的对应关系,为云文件A添加标签。在生成云文件A与目标标签的对应关系时,客户端可以将该对应关系中目标标签的标签类型设置为自动添加类型,表示云文件A的目标标签是客户端基于对其他对象触发的标签添加操作自动添加的。
需要说明的是,在不矛盾的情况下,本实施例所描述的方法与前述实施例所描述的方法可以组合。并且,组合得到的方案也涵盖在本公开实施例的保护范围之内。
上面介绍了为第一对象和第二对象添加标签的方法。在生成了第一对应关系和第二对应关系后,客户端还可以关联显示第一对象和目标标签,和/或,关联显示第二对象和目标标签。
需要说明的是,本实施例中所述的“用户”和图2所示实施例中所述的“用户”可以是相同的用户,也可以是不同的用户。例如,在项目协作的场景下,本实施例所述的“用户”和前述实施例中所述的“用户”可以不 同。即,在同一项目下协作的多个用户,当其中一个用户为项目中某个对象添加了标签后,客户端可以自动为相关联的其他对象添加标签,并向所述多个用户中其他用户展示标签。
在展示目标标签和具有目标标签的第一对象以及第二对象之前,可以先判断当前的登录客户端的用户是否属于共享范围。其中,共享范围为预先设置的,具有目标标签、第一对象和第二对象三者的查看权限的用户。如果当前登录客户端的用户属于共享范围内的用户,可以向该用户关联呈现目标标签和第一对象,也可以向用户关联成像目标标签和第二对象。例如,客户端可以在显示第一对象的界面中关联显示目标标签,也可以在显示目标标签的界面中关联显示第二对象。
在本申请实施例中,客户端可以在显示第一对象或第二对象对应的界面中显示目标标签,也可以基于用户的操作跳转到目标标签的标签展示界面。下面进行详细介绍。
在第一种可能的实现中,客户端可以在显示第一对象或第二对象对应的界面中显示目标标签。具体地,客户端可以在显示第一对象或第二对象的界面中显示目标标签。例如,假设第一对象为即时通讯群组,客户端可以在显示即时通讯群组标题的界面(例如图2中标题显示界面210)中显示该即时通讯群组的目标标签。当然,在一些其他的实现方式中,客户端也可以显示在第一对象或第二对象的界面中显示标签查看控件。在接收到用户对标签查看控件触发的标签查看操作后,再显示目标标签。
在第二种可能的实现方式中,客户端可以基于用户的操作跳转到目标标签的标签展示界面,并在该标签展示界面中展示第一对象和第二对象。下面进行详细介绍。
在本申请实施例中,客户端可以根据用户触发的跳转操作显示标签浏览界面,并在标签浏览界面显示用户可以查看的(例如用户具有查看权限的)至少一个标签。通过对标签浏览界面中任意一个标签进行操作,用户可以控制客户端跳转到该标签对应的标签展示页面。在标签展示界面中,客户端可以展示具有该标签的至少一个对象。
也就是说,当用户想要查看具有目标标签的对象时,用户可以先触发跳转操作,控制客户端显示标签浏览界面。接着,用户可以对标签浏览界 面中显示的目标标签进行操作,控制客户端进一步显示目标标签的标签展示界面,从而在目标标签的标签展示界面中查看具有目标标签的对象。
在本申请实施例中,标签查看控件可以位于客户端的初始界面,也可以位于其他任意界面。相应的,用户可以在客户端的初始界面或其他任意界面触发标签查看操作。
下面以用户在即时通讯群组的界面触发跳转操作为例对上述过程进行说明。
如图4所示,当客户端显示群聊即时通讯消息界面时,显示区域内可以包括标题显示区域410、消息显示区域420和控件显示区域430。其中,标题显示区域410用于显示客户端的基本信息,例如在图4中,标题显示区域410显示客户端上正在运行的软件名为“软件X”。消息显示区域420用于显示群聊即时通讯消息。关于消息显示区域420中细节的介绍可以参见上文,这里不再赘述。
控件显示区域430用于显示至少一个操作控件,在图4所示实施例中,控件显示区域430包括消息查看控件431、通讯录查看控件432和跳转控件433。其中,消息查看控件431用于在触发后使得客户端显示群聊即时通讯消息。在图4所示实施例中,消息查看控件431处于已经被触发的状态。通讯录查看控件432用于在触发后使得客户端显示通讯录。在图4所示实施例中,通讯录查看控件432处于未被触发的状态。跳转控件433用于在触发后使得客户端显示至少一个标签。在图4所示实施例中,跳转433处于未被触发的状态。
在用户触发跳转控件433之后,客户端可以接收到用户触发的跳转操作,从而跳转到标签浏览界面。可选地,该标签浏览界面可以如图5所示。
当客户端显示标签了浏览界面时,显示区域内可以包括标题显示区域510、控件显示区域520、搜索控件530、排序信息显示区域540和标签显示区域550。
其中,标题显示区域510用于显示客户端的基本信息;控件显示区域520包括跳转控件521。在图5所示的实施例中,跳转控件521处于已经被触发的状态;搜索控件530用于接收用户输入的关键词,并搜索与关键词相匹配的标签;排序信息显示区域540用于显示标签显示区域550中各个 标签卡片的排序规则。在图5所示的实施例中,排序信息显示区域540显示的内容为“最近”,表示说明标签显示区域550中标签的排序规则为按标签访问时间排序,最后一个访问的标签排在最前。
标签显示区域550可以用于显示一个或多个标签卡片,每个标签卡片可以显示一个标签的相关信息。在图5所示实施例中,标签显示区域550中包括第一标签卡片551、第二标签卡片552、第三标签卡片553和未完全显示的第四标签卡片854。其中,第一标签卡片551包括颜色标识区域551-1和标签名称显示区域551-2。其中,颜色标识区域551-1显示的颜色用于表示第一标签551的创建者,标签名称显示区域551-2用于显示第一标签551的名称。在图5所示的实施例中,第一标签卡片551对应的颜色为黑色,表示第一标签卡片551当前显示的标签“开会”是由当前登录客户端的用户创建的。在其他示例中,颜色标识区域551-1显示的颜色还可以用于表示其他内容,本申请实施例不做具体限定。
需要说明的是,在不矛盾的情况下,本实施例所描述的方法与前述实施例所描述的方法可以组合。并且,组合得到的方案也涵盖在本公开实施例的保护范围之内。
在标签显示界面中,用户可以触发对任意一个标签的操作,从而控制客户端显示具有该标签的至少一个对象。可选地,客户端可以以列表的方式展示具有相同标签的至少一个对象。
具体的,如图6-a所示,当客户端以列表的形式显示具有目标标签的至少一个对象时,显示区域内可以包括标题显示区域610、控件显示区域620和标签显示区域630。其中,关于标题显示区域610和控件显示区域620的介绍可以参见上文,这里不再赘述。
标签显示区域630包括标签切换控件631、标签名称显示区域632、标签域显示区域633和至少一个对象信息显示区域。
其中,标签切换控件631用于切换至其他标签。当用户想要查看其他标签时,可以触发标签切换控件631;标签名称显示区域632用于显示标签的名称。例如,在图6-a所示的实施例中,用户可以根据标签名称显示区域632确定当前显示的对象属于“开会”这一标签。
标签域显示区域633可以体现当前显示的对象来源的标签域,还可以 用于切换显示来源于其他标签域的对象。如图6-a所示,标签域显示区域633包括第一标签域名称633-1、第二标签域名称633-2和标注信息633-3。其中第一标签域名称633-1为“消息”,表示来源于该标签域的对象为即时通讯消息;第二标签域名称633-2为“群组”,表示来源于该标签域的对象为即时通讯群组;标注信息633-3用于标注客户端当前显示的对象所属的标签域。在图6-a所示的实施例中,标注信息633-3与第一标签域名称633-1相关,表示客户端当前显示的对象来源于“即时通讯消息”这一标签域。
当然,在一些可能的实现中,也可以不根据标签域对对象进行分类。那么相应的,标签显示区域630可以不包括标签域显示区域633。
在本申请实施例中,标签显示区域630可以包括一个或多个对象显示区域,每个对象显示区域可以用于显示一个具有目标标签的对象。下面以标签显示区域630包括对象显示区域634为例进行说明。
如图6-a所示,当客户端显示的对象为属于“即时通讯消息”这一标签域的对象时,对象显示区域634可以包括头像显示是由用户对第一对象触发的删除操作触发的其中,头像显示区域634-1用于显示发送该即时通讯消息的用户的头像。内容显示区域634-2可以显示即时通讯消息的具体内容。可选的,当即时通讯消息的具体内容较多时,内容显示区域634-2可以显示部分即时通讯消息,例如消息的前十个字等。对象信息显示区域634-3用于显示即时通讯消息的其他信息,例如在图6-a所示的实施例中,对象信息显示区域634-3中显示即时通讯消息发送的时间。当然,对象信息显示区域634-3也可以显示其他信息,例如可以显示即时通讯消息所属的即时通讯群组等信息。可选地,当对象显示区域显示的对象属于“云文件”等标签域时,对象显示区域内可以显示对象的信息块,例如可以显示对象的摘要信息。
可选的,标签显示区域630还可以包括指示信息,用于提示用户对象显示区域中各个显示区域显示的内容。例如,在图6-a所示的实施例中,标签显示区域630包括“消息内容”和“最近发送”两个指示信息。其中“消息内容”这一提示信息用于提示用户下方的对象显示区域中对应的位置用于显示即时通讯消息的内容。“最近发送”这一提示信息用于提示用户下方各个对象显示区域中的显示的对象是按照即时通讯消息的发送时间的先后 顺序排列的。
在标签展示界面中,用户可以对查看具有目标标签的至少一个对象。其中,该至少一个对象中既有标签是根据针对该对象的标签添加操作添加的对象,也有标签是根据针对其他对象的标签添加操作自动添加的对象。也就是说,标签展示界面中显示的对象既包括第一对象,也包括与第一对象相关联的第二对象。为了将第一对象和第二对象区分开来,标签显示界面可以包括标签类型显示区域,用于体现对象的标签是通过何种方式添加的。
具体的,如图6-b所示,对象显示区域634可以包括标签类型显示区域634-4,表示对象显示区域634中显示的这条即时通讯消息的标签是自动添加的,即该对象具有的“开会”这一标签的标签类型为自动添加类型。
需要说明的是,在不矛盾的情况下,本实施例所描述的方法与前述实施例所描述的方法可以组合。并且,组合得到的方案也涵盖在本公开实施例的保护范围之内。
在一些可能的实现中,具有相同的目标标签的多个对象中可以包括至少两个第一对象,和分别与该至少两个第一对象相关联的第二对象,即至少两个第二对象的标签可以是基于不同的标签添加操作添加的。举例说明。具有目标标签的对象可以包括第一对象A和第一对象B,以及与第一对象A相关联的第二对象C和与第一对象B相关联的第二对象D。
那么,为了区分与不同第一对象相关联的第二对象,客户端可以在标签展示界面中显示筛选控件。该筛选控件用于筛选出与一个或多个的第一对象相关联的第二对象。具体地,当用户想要查看与目标第一对象相关联的第二对象时,可以在标签展示界面中对筛选控件触发筛选操作。在接收到筛选操作后,可以根据筛选操作确定目标第一对象,并显示与目标第一对象相关联的第二对象。
具体地,如图6-c所示,标签显示界面可以包括筛选控件640。当检测到用户触发了筛选控件640后,用户可以展示候选界面650。候选界面650可以包括第一筛选控件651、第二筛选控件652、第三筛选控件653和第四筛选控件。其中,第一筛选控件651用于控制显示与全部第一对象相关联的第二对象;第二筛选控件652用于控制显示与第一对象“群组A”相关 联的第二对象;第三筛选控件653用于控制显示与第一对象“群组B”相关联的第二对象;第四筛选控件654用于控制客户显示与第一对象“群组C”相关联的第二对象。
可选地,候选界面650还包括第一状态显示区域655、第二状态显示区域656、第三状态显示区域657和第四状态显示区域658。其中,第一状态显示区域655用于显示第一筛选控件651的触发情况;第二状态显示区域656用于显示第二筛选控件652的触发情况;第三状态显示区域657用于显示第一筛选控件653的触发情况;第四状态显示区域658用于显示第四筛选控件654的触发情况。在图6-c所示的实施例中,第一筛选控件651和第三筛选控件653处于未被触发的状态,第二筛选控件652和第四筛选控件654处于被触发的状态,表示对象显示区域634中显示的对象包括与第一对象“群组A”和第一对象“群组C”相关联的第二对象,不包括与第一对象“群组B”相关联的第二对象。
需要说明的是,在不矛盾的情况下,本实施例所描述的方法与前述实施例所描述的方法可以组合。并且,组合得到的方案也涵盖在本公开实施例的保护范围之内。
上面对本申请实施例提供的信息交互的方法进行了介绍。通过执行本申请实施例提供的信息交互方法,可以根据用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作为第一对象和至少一个与第一对象相关联的第二对象添加目标标签。此外,本申请实施例还提供了对应的标签删除方法,用于删除第二对象的目标标签。下面进行详细介绍。
参见图7,图7为本申请实施例提供的标签删除方法的流程示意图,该方法可以由客户端或服务器执行,该客户端(或服务器)可以和图1所示实施例中客户端(或服务器)是相同的客户端(或服务器),也可以是不同的客户端(或服务器)。本实施例中所述的用户和上文所述的用户可以是相同的用户,也可以是不同的用户。本申请实施例提供的标签删除方法具体包括以下步骤:
例如,在项目协作的场景下,本实施例所述的“用户”和前述实施例中所述的“用户”可以不同。即,在同一项目下协作的多个用户,用户可以删除其他用户为对象添加的标签,客户端可以基于该对象标签的删除自动删 除与该对象相关联的其他对象的同一标签。
S701:接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作。
在本申请实施例中,客户端或服务器可以接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作,从而根据标签删除操作删除第一对象和第二对象的目标标签。与图1所示的信息交互的方法类似,第一对象可以是文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组等对象中的任意一种,第二对象可以是文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组等对象中任意一种与第一对象相关联的对象。
可选地,标签删除操作可以是针对第一对象的目标标签触发的,也可以是由用户对第一对象触发的删除操作触发的。下面对这两种实现方式分别介绍。
首先介绍第一种实现方式。在第一种实现方式中,标签删除操作是用户对第一对象的目标标签触发的。也就是说,用户触发标签删除操作的目的是删除第一对象的目标标签,并不删除第一对象或第二对象。可选地,该标签删除操作可以是用户对标签删除控件触发的。其中,标签删除控件用于删除第一对象的目标标签。
如果标签删除操作是用户对第一对象的目标标签触发的,用户可以在显示第一对象的界面中触发标签删除操作,也可以在显示目标标签的界面中触发标签删除操作。下面对这两种情况进行介绍。
在第一种情况中,用户在显示第一对象的界面中通过标签删除控件触发标签删除操作。例如,客户端可以在显示第一对象的界面中显示标签删除控件,用户可以通过点击客户端显示的标签删除控件触发标签删除操作。
举例说明。假设第一对象为即时通讯群组,那么客户端可以在显示即时通讯群组的界面中显示标签删除控件,例如可以在图2或图3所示的界面中显示标签删除控件。用户可以通过点击客户端显示的标签删除控件触发标签删除操作。在本申请实施例中,标签删除控件可以用于删除第一对象的目标标签,也可以用于删除第一对象的全部标签。
此外,在一些其他的实现中,客户端还可以基于用户触发的显示操作显示标签删除控件,以便用户对标签删除控件触发标签删除操作。也就是说,客户端可以先隐藏标签删除控件,并基于用户触发的显示操作显示标 签添加控件,以便用户通过标签删除控件触发标签删除操作。
举例说明,假设第一对象为文件夹,客户端可以在显示文件夹的界面中不显示标签删除控件。并基于用户的右键点击操作(相当于前述显示操作)显示操作控件列表,该操作控件列表包括标签删除控件。
在第二种情况中,用户在显示目标标签的界面中触发标签删除操作。具体的,客户端可以在如图6-b或图6-c所示的标签展示界面中显示标签删除控件,以便用户通过该标签删除控件触发标签删除操作。
如图6-d所示,当客户端在标签展示界面中展示标签删除控件时,对象显示区域634可以包括标签删除控件634-5。用户可以通过该标签删除控件634-5触发标签删除操作,该标签删除操作用于删除即时通信消息“开会讨论的主题是……”的标签“开会”。
下面介绍第二种实现方式。在第二种实现方式中,用户想要删除第一对象,并对第一对象触发了删除操作,可以基于用户触发的删除操作删除第一对象。基于此,还可以删除第一对象和目标标签之间的对应关系,即标签删除操作是由用户对第一对象触发的删除操作触发的。
具体地,用户可以触发对第一对象的删除操作,在接收到用户触发的删除操作后,基于该删除操作判断第一对象是否具有标签。若具有,可以根据用户触发的删除操作获取标签删除操作,从而根据该标签删除操作删除第一对象的标签。
需要说明的是,当标签删除操作由对第一对象的删除操作触发时,该标签删除操作既可以用于删除第一对象的目标标签,也可以用于删除第一对象的除目标标签以外的其他标签。
S702:根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系。
在接收到标签删除操作后,可以根据该标签删除操作删除第一对应关系。第一对应关系为第一对象和目标标签之间的对应关系。可选地,在删除第一对应关系前,可以根据标签删除操作确定第一对象和目标标签,从而确定第一对应关系。
S703:响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系。
在确定删除第一对应关系后,可以删除第二对应关系。第二对应关系为第二对象和目标标签之间的对应关系,第二对象为与前述第二对象相关 联的对象。关于第一对象、第二对象、第一对应关系和第二对应关系的介绍可以参见图2所示实施例的介绍,这里不再赘述。
可见,在本申请实施例提供的标签删除方法中,可以基于对第一对象的标签删除操作删除第一对象的标签,并基于“第一对象的标签被删除”自动删除第二对象的标签。如此,当用户想要批量删除多个对象的标签时,只需对其中的各个第一对象触发标签删除操作即可,无需分别针对每个对象触发标签删除操作。
在本申请实施例中,第二对应关系的删除是基于对第一对应关系的删除自动进行的。因此,在删除第二对应关系之前,可以先确定将要被删除的第二对应关系。具体地,可以先根据标签删除操作确定第一对应关系,再根据第一对应关系确定第二对应关系,从而删除第二对应关系。
由于第一对应关系为目标标签和第一对象之间的对应关系,在根据第一对应关系确定第二对应关系时,客户端或服务器可以采用两种不同的方式确定第二对应关系。下面分别进行介绍。
在第一种可能的方式中,可以根据第一对象确定第二对象,根据第一对应关系确定目标标签,再根据第二对象和目标标签确定并删除第二对应关系。具体的,可以在接收到第二对象时记录第二对象和第一对象之间的关联关系。在检测到用户对第一对象触发了标签删除操作后,可以根据记录的关联关系确定与第一对象相关联的第二对象。另外,还可以根据第一对应关系确定待删除的目标标签。在确定目标标签和第二对象后,可以删除目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,即第二对应关系。
在第二种可能的方式中,可以先确定待删除的目标标签,并从具有该目标标签的对象中筛选出与第一对象相关联的第二对象,再根据第二对象和目标标签确定并删除第二对应关系。具体的,可以先根据第一对应关系确定目标标签,并获取至少一个与该目标标签相对应的对象。接着,可以逐一判断该至少一个对象中每个对象是否与第一对象相关联。若某具有目标标签的对象与第一对象相关联,可以将该对象确定为第二对象,从而删除该第二对象的目标标签。
在删除第二对应关系之前,客户端或服务器可以判断第二对应关系是否为自动生成的,即第二对应关系是否为基于对第一对象触发的标签添加 操作生成的。如果第二对应关系是自动生成的,可以基于第一对应关系被删除自动删除第二对应关系;如果第二对应关系不是自动生成的,说明用户单独对第二对象触发了标签添加操作,可以保留第二对应关系。
具体的,可以判断第二对应关系中目标标签的标签类型是否为自动添加类型。如果第二对应关系中目标标签的标签类型是自动添加类型,说明第二对应关系是基于对第一对象触发的标签添加操作自动生成的,那么第二对应关系也可以基于对第一对象触发的标签删除操作自动删除,客户端或服务器可以根据前述标签删除操作删除第二对应关系。相反的,如果第二对应关系中目标标签的标签类型不是自动添加类型,客户端或服务器可以不删除第二对应关系。例如,如果第二对应关系中目标标签的标签类型是手动添加类型,说明第二对应关系是基于用户对第二对象触发的标签添加操作生成的,可以保留第二对应关系。
在实际的应用场景中,第二对象可能与多个对象相关联。那么,如果用户删除了其中任意一个对象的目标标签,且没有删除其他对象的目标标签,可以保留第二对象与目标标签之间的对应关系。如果与第二对象相关联的全部对象的目标标签全部被删除,可以删除第二对应关系。
举例说明。假设第一对象与第二对象相关联、第三对象也与第二对象相关联,且第一对象、第二对象和第三对象都具有目标标签。第三对象与目标标签之间的对应关系为第三对应关系。
在接收到用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作后,客户端或服务器可以根据标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,并根据第一对应关系确定第二对象和第二对应关系。接着,可以判断该第二对象是否与其他对象相关联。由于第二对象还与第三对象相关联,可以保留第二对应关系,不删除第二对象的目标标签。
在接收到用户对第三对象触发的标签删除操作后,可以进一步判断第二对象是否与目标对象集合中除第一对象和第二对象以外的其他对象相关联。其中,目标对象集合包括至少一个具有目标标签的对象(例如第一对象和第三对象)。如果第二对象与目标对象集合中除第一对象和第二对象以外的任意一个对象相关联,可以保留第二对应关系。如果第二对象与目标对象集合中任意一个对象均不关联,可以删除第二对应关系。在删除第二 对应关系前,可以在目标标签的标签展示界面中展示第二对象。
需要说明的是,在不矛盾的情况下,本实施例所描述的方法与前述实施例所描述的方法可以组合。并且,组合得到的方案也涵盖在本公开实施例的保护范围之内。
在实际的应用场景中,用户可能在即时通讯软件中发送了错误的消息或文件,容易给该即时通讯群组中的其他用户造成困扰。为了解决这一问题,即时通讯软件可以具有撤回功能,用户可以对已发送的即时通讯消息或文件触发撤回操作,从而删除误发送的即时通讯消息或文件。
根据前文介绍可知,本申请实施例提供的信息交互的方法可以自动为第一对象相关联的第二对象添加目标标签。那么,当第一对象为即时通讯群组时,如果用户在该即时通讯群组中发送了错误的即时通讯消息或文件,客户端或服务器可能会自动为该即时通讯消息或文件添加目标标签。但是,由于该即时通讯消息或文件是错误地发送到即时通讯群组中的,用户实际上可能并不想为该即时通讯消息或文件添加目标标签。
为了解决这一问题,在本申请实施例提供的方法中,客户端或服务器还可以根据用户触发的撤回操作删除自动生成的第二对应关系。
参见图8,图8为本申请实施例提供的标签删除方法的另一种流程示意图,该方法具体包括以下步骤:
S801:接收用户触发的第一撤回操作。
在删除第二对应关系之前,客户端或服务器可以先接收用户触发的第一撤回操作,该第一撤回操作用于解除第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系。当第一对象为即时通讯群组时,解除第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系相当于将第二对象从即时通讯群组中撤回。
在本申请实施例中,用户可以通过撤回控件触发第一撤回操作。例如,当第一对象为即时通讯群组时,客户端可以基于用户的操作显示第二对象对应的撤回控件,例如客户端可以基于用户的右键点击操作或长按操作显示与第二对象对应的撤回控件。当然,客户端也可以在显示第二对象的界面中直接显示与第二对象对应的撤回控件,以便用户通过该撤回控件触发第一撤回操作。
S802:根据所述第一撤回操作删除所述第二对应关系。
在接收到第一撤回操作后,客户端或服务器可以根据第一撤回操作删除第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系,并基于第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系被解除删除第二对应关系。这样,如果发送了错误的第二对象,用户可以通过触发第一撤回操作撤回该第二对象。在用户撤回第二对象的后,还可以基于“第二对象从第一对象中被撤回”删除第二对象的目标标签。如此,根据用户的第一撤回操作自动删除第二对象的目标标签,无需用户在撤回第二对象后再触发标签删除操作删除第二对象的目标标签。
与S702类似,在执行S802时,可以判断第二对象是否还与其他具有目标标签的对象相关联。如果第二对象与其余全部具有目标标签的对象均不关联,可以根据第一撤回操作自动删除第二对应关系;如果第二对象与任意一个具有目标标签的对象关联,可以不自动删除第二对应关系。
假设第二对象还与第三对象相关联,客户端或服务器可以根据第一撤回操作删除第一对象和第二对象之间的关联关系。如果第二对象和第三对象之间的关联关系也被解除,可以基于第二对象和第三对象之间的关联关系的解除自动删除第二对应关系。相似的,如果接收到了对第三对象触发的标签删除操作,可以自动删除第二对应关系。如果既没有接收到第二撤回操作,也没有接收到对第三对象触发的标签删除操作,可以保留第二对象的目标标签。可选地,可以在目标标签的标签展示界面展示第二对象。
举例说明。假设即时通讯群组A和即时通讯群组B具有标签X,且用户在即时通讯群组A和即时通讯群组B中均发送了云文件Y。那么,如果用户想要撤回即时通讯群组A中的云文件Y,可以触发第一撤回操作,该第一撤回操作用于接触即时通讯群组A和云文件Y之间的关联关系。在接收到第一撤回操作后,由于云文件Y还与即时通讯群组B相关联,可以保留云文件Y与标签X之间的对应关系,解除云文件Y和即时通讯群组A之间的关联关系。
如果用户触发了用于在即时通讯群组B中撤回云文件Y的第二撤回操作,或触发对即时通讯群组B触发了标签删除操作,且云文件Y与目标对象集合中除第一对象和第三对象以外的其他对象均不关联,可以删除第二对应关系。
需要说明的是,在不矛盾的情况下,本实施例所描述的方法与前述实施例所描述的方法可以组合。并且,组合得到的方案也涵盖在本公开实施例的保护范围之内。
图9为本申请实施例提供的一种信息交互装置的结构示意图,本实施例可以适用于在客户端中为第一对象添加目标标签,并自动为第二对象添加目标标签的情况,该装置具体包括接收模块910、第一生成模块920和第二生成模块930。
其中,接收模块910,用于接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作。
第一生成模块920,用于根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系。
第二生成模块930,用于响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
本公开实施例所提供的信息交互的装置可执行本公开任意实施例所提供的信息交互的方法,具备执行信息交互的方法相应的功能模块和有益效果。值得注意的是,上述信息交互的装置的实施例中,所包括的各个单元和模块只是按照功能逻辑进行划分的,但并不局限于上述的划分,只要能够实现相应的功能即可;另外,各功能单元的具体名称也只是为了便于相互区分,并不用于限制本公开的保护范围
图10为本申请实施例提供的一种信息交互装置的结构示意图,本实施例可以适用于在客户端中删除第一对象的目标标签,并自动删除第二对象的目标标签的情况,该装置具体包括接收模块1010、第一删除模块1020和第二删除模块1030。
其中,接收模块1010,用于接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作。
第一删除模块1020,用于根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系。
第二删除模块1030,用于响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
本公开实施例所提供的信息交互的装置可执行本公开任意实施例所提供的信息交互的方法,具备执行信息交互的方法相应的功能模块和有益效果。值得注意的是,上述信息交互的装置的实施例中,所包括的各个单元和模块只是按照功能逻辑进行划分的,但并不局限于上述的划分,只要能够实现相应的功能即可;另外,各功能单元的具体名称也只是为了便于相互区分,并不用于限制本公开的保护范围
下面参考图11,其示出了适于用来实现本公开实施例的电子设备(例如运行有客户端的终端设备或服务器)1100的结构示意图。本公开实施例中的终端设备可以包括但不限于诸如移动电话、笔记本电脑、数字广播接收器、PDA(个人数字助理)、PAD(平板电脑)、PMP(便携式多媒体播放器)、车载终端(例如车载导航终端)等等的移动终端以及诸如数字TV、台式计算机等等的固定终端。图11示出的电子设备仅仅是一个示例,不应对本公开实施例的功能和使用范围带来任何限制。
如图11所示,电子设备1100可以包括处理装置(例如中央处理器、图形处理器等)1101,其可以根据存储在只读存储器(ROM)1102中的程序或者从存储装置1108加载到随机访问存储器(RAM)1103中的程序而执行各种适当的动作和处理。在RAM 1103中,还存储有电子设备1100操作所需的各种程序和数据。处理装置1101、ROM 1102以及RAM 1103通过总线1104彼此相连。输入/输出(I/O)接口1105也连接至总线1104。
通常,以下装置可以连接至I/O接口1105:包括例如触摸屏、触摸板、键盘、鼠标、摄像头、麦克风、加速度计、陀螺仪等的输入装置1106;包括例如液晶显示器(LCD)、扬声器、振动器等的输出装置1107;包括例如磁带、硬盘等的存储装置1108;以及通信装置1109。通信装置1109可以允许电子设备1100与其他设备进行无线或有线通信以交换数据。虽然图11示出了具有各种装置的电子设备1100,但是应理解的是,并不要求实施或具备所有示出的装置。可以替代地实施或具备更多或更少的装置。
特别地,根据本公开的实施例,上文参考流程图描述的过程可以被实现为计算机软件程序。例如,本公开的实施例包括一种计算机程序产品,其包括承载在非暂态计算机可读介质上的计算机程序,该计算机程序包含 用于执行流程图所示的方法的程序代码。在这样的实施例中,该计算机程序可以通过通信装置1109从网络上被下载和安装,或者从存储装置1108被安装,或者从ROM 1102被安装。在该计算机程序被处理装置1101执行时,执行本公开实施例的方法中限定的上述功能。
本公开实施例提供的电子设备与上述实施例提供的信息交互的方法以及标签删除方法属于同一发明构思,未在本公开实施例中详尽描述的技术细节可参见上述实施例,并且本公开实施例与上述实施例具有相同的有益效果。
本公开实施例提供了一种计算机存储介质,其上存储有计算机程序,该程序被处理器执行时实现上述实施例所提供的信息交互的方法或标签删除方法。
需要说明的是,本公开上述的计算机可读介质可以是计算机可读信号介质或者计算机可读存储介质或者是上述两者的任意组合。计算机可读存储介质例如可以是——但不限于——电、磁、光、电磁、红外线、或半导体的系统、装置或器件,或者任意以上的组合。计算机可读存储介质的更具体的例子可以包括但不限于:具有一个或多个导线的电连接、便携式计算机磁盘、硬盘、随机访问存储器(RAM)、只读存储器(ROM)、可擦式可编程只读存储器(EPROM或闪存)、光纤、便携式紧凑磁盘只读存储器(CD-ROM)、光存储器件、磁存储器件、或者上述的任意合适的组合。在本公开中,计算机可读存储介质可以是任何包含或存储程序的有形介质,该程序可以被指令执行系统、装置或者器件使用或者与其结合使用。而在本公开中,计算机可读信号介质可以包括在基带中或者作为载波一部分传播的数据信号,其中承载了计算机可读的程序代码。这种传播的数据信号可以采用多种形式,包括但不限于电磁信号、光信号或上述的任意合适的组合。计算机可读信号介质还可以是计算机可读存储介质以外的任何计算机可读介质,该计算机可读信号介质可以发送、传播或者传输用于由指令执行系统、装置或者器件使用或者与其结合使用的程序。计算机可读介质上包含的程序代码可以用任何适当的介质传输,包括但不限于:电线、光缆、RF(射频)等等,或者上述的任意合适的组合。
在一些实施方式中,客户端、服务器可以利用诸如HTTP(HyperText  Transfer Protocol,超文本传输协议)之类的任何当前已知或未来研发的网络协议进行通信,并且可以与任意形式或介质的数字数据通信(例如,通信网络)互连。通信网络的示例包括局域网(“LAN”),广域网(“WAN”),网际网(例如,互联网)以及端对端网络(例如,ad hoc端对端网络),以及任何当前已知或未来研发的网络。
上述计算机可读介质可以是上述电子设备中所包含的;也可以是单独存在,而未装配入该电子设备中。
上述计算机可读介质承载有一个或者多个程序,当上述一个或者多个程序被该电子设备执行时,使得该电子设备:接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作;根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。或使得该电子设备:接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作;根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
可以以一种或多种程序设计语言或其组合来编写用于执行本公开的操作的计算机程序代码,上述程序设计语言包括但不限于面向对象的程序设计语言—诸如Java、Smalltalk、C++,还包括常规的过程式程序设计语言—诸如“C”语言或类似的程序设计语言。程序代码可以完全地在用户计算机上执行、部分地在用户计算机上执行、作为一个独立的软件包执行、部分在用户计算机上部分在远程计算机上执行、或者完全在远程计算机或服务器上执行。在涉及远程计算机的情形中,远程计算机可以通过任意种类的网络——包括局域网(LAN)或广域网(WAN)—连接到用户计算机,或者,可以连接到外部计算机(例如利用因特网服务提供商来通过因特网连接)。
附图中的流程图和框图,图示了按照本公开各种实施例的系统、方法和计算机程序产品的可能实现的体系架构、功能和操作。在这点上,流程图或框图中的每个方框可以代表一个模块、程序段、或代码的一部分,该 模块、程序段、或代码的一部分包含一个或多个用于实现规定的逻辑功能的可执行指令。也应当注意,在有些作为替换的实现中,方框中所标注的功能也可以以不同于附图中所标注的顺序发生。例如,两个接连地表示的方框实际上可以基本并行地执行,它们有时也可以按相反的顺序执行,这依所涉及的功能而定。也要注意的是,框图和/或流程图中的每个方框、以及框图和/或流程图中的方框的组合,可以用执行规定的功能或操作的专用的基于硬件的系统来实现,或者可以用专用硬件与计算机指令的组合来实现。
描述于本公开实施例中所涉及到的单元可以通过软件的方式实现,也可以通过硬件的方式来实现。其中,单元的名称在某种情况下并不构成对该单元本身的限定,例如,可编辑内容显示单元还可以被描述为“编辑单元”。
本文中以上描述的功能可以至少部分地由一个或多个硬件逻辑部件来执行。例如,非限制性地,可以使用的示范类型的硬件逻辑部件包括:现场可编程门阵列(FPGA)、专用集成电路(ASIC)、专用标准产品(ASSP)、片上系统(SOC)、复杂可编程逻辑设备(CPLD)等等。
在本公开的上下文中,机器可读介质可以是有形的介质,其可以包含或存储以供指令执行系统、装置或设备使用或与指令执行系统、装置或设备结合地使用的程序。机器可读介质可以是机器可读信号介质或机器可读储存介质。机器可读介质可以包括但不限于电子的、磁性的、光学的、电磁的、红外的、或半导体系统、装置或设备,或者上述内容的任何合适组合。机器可读存储介质的更具体示例会包括基于一个或多个线的电气连接、便携式计算机盘、硬盘、随机存取存储器(RAM)、只读存储器(ROM)、可擦除可编程只读存储器(EPROM或快闪存储器)、光纤、便捷式紧凑盘只读存储器(CD-ROM)、光学储存设备、磁储存设备、或上述内容的任何合适组合。
目前,一些应用程序可以提供任务创建功能。在一个示例中,还可以为任务添加标签。在实际应用中,对于某一用户而言,若其参与多人协作完 成的多个项目,则该用户既有查看与某一个项目相关的任务的需求,又有对与自身相关的任务进行集中查看和管理的需求。若用户需要查看与自身相关的任务,需要分别打开与各个任务所具备的标签的页面,以查看所述各个任务。用户操作繁琐,效率低下。
本申请的发明人经过研究发现,对于某一用户而言,可能与其相关的任务有很多,若用户需要查看与自身相关的任务,需要分别打开与各个任务所具备的标签的关联页面,以查看所述各个任务。例如,与用户A相关的任务有3个,这三个任务分别具备标签1、标签2和标签3。则用户A需要打开标签1对应的页面以查看任务1,用户A需要打开标签2对应的页面以查看任务2,用户A需要打开标签3对应的页面以查看任务3。用户操作繁琐,效率低下。
为了解决上述问题,本申请实施例提供了一种基于任务的信息处理方法及装置。
参见图12,该图为本申请实施例提供的一种基于任务的信息处理方法的流程示意图。
本申请实施例提供的方法,可以由客户端执行,在本申请实施例中,所述客户端上可以安装有目标应用程序。本申请实施例中提及的第一用户,指的是在客户端上登录所述目标应用程序的账号所对应的用户。
本申请实施例附图中的“#”为标签识别符,当然,标签识别符不限于“#”,也可以是其它符号。
在不冲突的情况下,以下图12所示的方法和图14所示的方法,可以相互结合和引用。
本申请实施例中的所有附图,例如图13、图15a、图15b以及图15c,其只是为了方便理解与本申请实施例相关的内容而示出,其并不构成对本申请实施例的限定。图13、图15a、图15b以及图15c所示的页面中也可以还包括其它内容,本申请实施例不具体限定。
在本实施例中,图12所示的方法例如可以包括以下步骤:S1201-S1202。
S1201:获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务,所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享。
在本申请实施例中,所述与第一用户相关的任务,可以包括三种情况。第 一种情况是第一用户创建的任务,即创建者为第一用户的任务。第二种情况是第一用户为执行者的任务。例如,由第二用户创建,并且指定由包括第一用户的执行者执行的任务。又如,由第一用户自身创建,并且指定由第一用户执行的任务。第三种情况是第一用户关注的任务。例如,第一用户为项目主管,其关注了与该项目相关的任务,以获知该项目的执行进度。
需要说明的是,在本申请实施例中,所述标签不是仅能够在所述第一用户的客户端本地使用的标签,而是可以在一定范围内共享的标签。具体地,所述标签的共享范围,可以由所述标签的权限确定。接下来以第一标签为例,介绍所述标签的共享属性。
在一个示例中,所述第一标签的权限,可以包括使用权限。所谓使用权限,指的是为信息单元添加第一标签的权限。具体地,具备所述第一标签的使用权限的用户,均可以在其对应的客户端上为信息单元添加所述第一标签。其中,所述第一标签的使用权限,可以由所述第一标签的所有者设置,第一标签的所有者可以指定具备所述第一标签的使用权限的用户。
在又一个示例中,所述第一标签的权限,包括查看权限。所谓查看权限,指的是查看所述第一标签的关联信息的权限。具体地:具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户的客户端上,显示所述第一标签的关联信息。换言之,具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户,可以在其对应的客户端查看第一标签的关联信息。
在一些实施例中,考虑到信息单元本身也具备查看权限。则对于具备第一标签的查看权限的第一用户而言,所述第一用户的客户端上呈现的第一标签的关联信息,可以是所述第一用户具备查看权限的信息。换言之,所述第一用户的客户端上呈现的第一标签的关联信息,不包括所述第一用户不具备查看权限的信息。这样一来,可以有效保护信息安全,避免所述第一用户查看其不具备查看权限的信息而导致信息泄露。在一个示例中,对于第一用户具备查看权限的第一信息单元而言,若所述第一信息单元具备第一标签,则所述第一用户的客户端上,可以关联呈现所述第一标签和第一信息单元。这样一来,所述第一用户即可根据该关联呈现的所述第一标签和第一信息单元,确定第一信息单元的具体内容,并确定所述第一信息单元具备所述第一标签。
S1202:在第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,所述第一页面为:登录所述第一用户的账户的客户端上显示的页面。
获取所述至少一个任务之后,所述客户端可以在其显示的第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息。这样一来,第一用户可以在第一页面上查看与自身相关的至少一个任务的信息,而无需分别打开各个标签对应的页面,用户操作简单,也提升了用户查看与自身相关的任务的效率。
关于所述至少一个任务的信息,以所述至少一个任务中的第一任务为例。所述第一任务的信息,指的是与所述第一任务相关的信息。所述第一任务的信息,包括但不限于以下任意一项或者多项:
所述第一任务具备的标签、所述第一任务的创建者、所述第一任务的执行者、所述第一任务的截止日期、所述第一任务的状态以及所述第一任务的摘要信息。
其中:所述第一任务的状态可以包括:已完成或者未完成;所述第一任务的摘要信息,例如可以是所述第一任务的主题,又如可以是所述第一任务的任务描述中的关键字。
在一些实施例中,前述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,可以以列表形式在第一页面中显示。在以列表形式在所述第一页面中显示时,一个任务的信息可以对应所述列表中的一条记录,其中,每条任务的信息具体包括的内容由所述列表的表头指示。
例如,所述列表的表头包括:标签、创建者、执行者、截止日期、状态以及摘要信息。则所述至少一个任务中每个任务的信息,包括:所述每个任务具备的标签、所述每个任务的创建者、所述每个任务的执行者、所述每个任务的截止日期、所述每个任务的状态以及所述每个任务的摘要信息。作为一个示例,所述每个任务的执行者,可以是所述每个任务的执行者的用户名,也可以是所述每个任务的执行者的账户头像,本申请实施例不做具体限定。相应的,所述每个任务的创建者,可以是所述每个任务的创建者的用户名,也可以是所述每个任务的创建者的账户头像,本申请实施例不做具体限定。
需要说明的是,所述列表的表头具体包括的内容,可以是由第一用户自定义的。换言之,所述第一用户可以自主选择第一页面中所显示的所述至少一个任务中每个任务的信息具体包括的内容。
在一个示例中,所述第一用户可以针对所述表头触发任务信息选择操作,第一用户触发所述任务信息选择操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述任务信 息选择操作,确定所述第一页面上显示的所述每个任务的信息所包括的内容。在一些实施例中,所述表头可以默认包括:标签、创建者、执行者、截止日期、状态以及摘要信息。所述第一用户可以针对所述标签、创建者、执行者、截止日期、状态以及摘要信息中的其中一项或者多项触发取消操作,从而将部分信息从所述表头中删除。例如,所述第一用户点击了所述表头中的“创建者”,并进一步触发了删除所述“创建者”的控件,则所述列表的表头中则不再包括“创建者”,相应的,所述第一页面中也不再显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务的创建者。
在一些实施例中,考虑到任务具备截止日期,而截止日期距离当前日期越近,则表示用于完成该任务的剩余时间越少。在一个示例中,在所述第一页面中显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务的信息时,可以按照一定的顺序对所述每个任务的信息进行排序。具体地:所述至少一个任务中的每个任务的信息的排列顺序为:所述至少一个任务中每个任务的截止日期由近到远的顺序。这样一来,所述第一用户即可根据所述第一页面所显示的内容,直观的确定出举例截止日期比较近的任务,从而对工作进度进行合理安排,以免错过任务的截止日期。
在一些实施例中,考虑到对于与第一用户相关的任务而言,虽然有一些任务的截止日期距离当前日期较远,但是这些任务可能是第一用户重点关注的、或者说是紧急程度比较高的任务。对于这种情况,若按照截止日期进行排序,则这些任务的排序位置可能比较靠后,不利于第一用户直观的查看该任务的信息。鉴于此,在本申请实施例的一种实现方式中,所述第一用户可以对所述至少一个任务中的部分或者全部任务的显示位置进行调整。以第一任务为例,所述第一用户可以针对所述第一任务触发位置移动操作,例如将第一任务拖动至目标位置。第一用户针对第一任务触发位置移动操作之后,客户端可以响应于所述位置移动操作,修改所述第一任务在所述第一页面中的显示位置。所述第一任务在第一页面中的显示位置被修改之后,若用户下次访问用于呈现于所述用户相关的任务的信息的页面,则客户端所显示的页面中所述第一任务的显示位置,为前述修改之后的位置,以便于用户直观的查看所述第一任务的信息。
关于所述第一页面,可结合图13进行理解,图13为本申请实施例提供的一种第一页面的示意图。
如图13所示,第一页面中显示有与第一用户相关的多个任务的信息,所述多个任务的信息以列表形式呈现,一个任务的信息对应列表中的一条记录。且按照每个任务的截止日期由近到远的顺序排列。所述列表的表头包括:摘要信息、创建者、执行者、状态、标签以及截止日期。
在一个示例中,第一用户可以将“测试3”对应的任务,拖动至所述“测试1”对应的任务之前,以改变所述“测试3”对应的任务在第一页面中的显示位置。
在一个示例中,考虑到与第一用户相关的任务比较多,而第一用户可能对其中部分任务比较关注。因此,在一个示例中,所述目标应用程序还可以支持任务筛选功能。具体地:所述第一用户可以在所述第一页面中触发任务筛选操作。所述第一用户触发所述任务筛选操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述任务筛选操作,获取至少一个维度的筛选条件,并从所述至少一个任务中确定符合所述筛选条件的任务,进一步地,显示筛选得到的所述任务的信息。
在一个示例中,所述第一页面中可以包括任务筛选控件,所述第一用户触发所述任务筛选控件(例如点击所述任务筛选控件)之后,客户端可以显示任务筛选页面,所述第一用户可以在所述任务筛选页面中编辑至少一个维度的筛选条件。而后,客户端即可获取所述至少一个维度的筛选条件。
需要说明的是,此处提及的至少一个维度,可以是标签、创建者、执行者、截止日期、以及状态中的其中一项或者多项。例如,所述第一用户可以将筛选条件设置为:已完成、且执行者为用户A。又如,所述第一用户可以将筛选条件设置为:未完成、且截至日期在*年*月*日之前。再如,所述第一用户可以将筛选条件设置为:#A。此处不一一列举说明。
需要说明的是,对于所述至少一个任务中具备第一标签的第一任务而言,其可以是用户预先创建的。接下来,对创建所述第一任务以及为所述第一任务添加标签的具体实现方式进行介绍。
在本申请实施例中,若首先创建了第一标签,则用户可以在第一标签的相关页面中触发任务创建操作,从而创建具备第一标签的第一任务。
在一个示例中,可以在第一标签的概览页面中触发任务创建操作。所述用户触发任务创建操作之后,客户端可以响应于所述任务创建操作,创建所述第一任务。具体地,所述用户触发任务创建操作之后,客户端可以显示任务创建 页面,并获取所述用户在所述任务创建页面中输入的任务信息,从而创建所述第一任务。此处提及的用户,可以是前述第一用户,也可以是不同于第一用户的第二用户,此处不做限定。可以理解的是,若此处提及的用户是前述第一用户,则所述第一用户为所述第一任务的创建者。
关于第一标签的概览页面,需要说明的是,所述第一标签的概览页面,为对所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息分区域显示页面。其中,所述各个信息域,包括但不限于:任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组中的其中一项或者多项。具体地:在第一用户的客户端上,所述第一标签的概览页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签、且所述第一用户具备查看权限的各个信息域的信息。其中,所述概览页面中可以包括多个显示区域,一个显示区域用于显示所述各个信息域中的其中一个信息域的信息。本申请实施例中的信息域,用于提供某一类型的信息。其中,一个信息域可以对应一个服务提供方。
在又一个示例中,可以在第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面中触发任务创建操作。所述用户触发任务创建操作之后,客户端可以响应于所述任务创建操作,创建所述第一任务。具体地,所述用户触发任务创建操作之后,客户端可以显示任务创建页面,并获取所述用户在所述任务创建页面中输入的任务信息,从而创建所述第一任务。此处提及的用户,可以是前述第一用户,也可以是不同于第一用户的第二用户,此处不做限定。可以理解的是,若此处提及的用户是前述第一用户,则所述第一用户为所述第一任务的创建者。
关于第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面,需要说明的是,所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的任务的信息。具体地:在第一用户的客户端上,所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签、且所述第一用户具备查看权限的任务的信息。
在本申请实施例中,若首先创建了第一任务,则用户可以在第一任务对应的页面中触发标签添加操作,从而为所述第一任务添加所述第一标签。此处提及的用户,可以是前述第一用户,也可以是不同于第一用户的第二用户,此处不做限定。
在一个示例中,所述用户在第一任务对应的页面中触发标签添加操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述标签添加操作,并获取所述标签添加操作对应的所述第一标签,进一步地保存所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系,从而达 到为所述第一任务添加所述第一标签的目的。具体地:
在一种实现方式中:所述用户在第一任务对应的页面中触发标签添加操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述标签添加操作,显示字符输入区。而后,所述用户可以在所述字符输入区输入字符。用户可以在该字符输入区输入第一标签所包括的至少一部分字符。相应的,客户端获取到所述用户输入的字符之后,可以根据所述用户输入的字符,为所述用户提供对应的标签候选项,并显示所述标签候选项,以便于用户基于所述标签候选项选择所述第一标签。当所述用户选择所述第一标签之后,即所述用户针对所述标签候选项中的所述第一标签触发了选择操作,例如点击了所述第一标签,则所述客户端可以获取所述第一标签,并进一步保存所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系。
在又一种实现方式中:所述用户在第一任务对应的页面中触发标签添加操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述标签添加操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,显示所述至少一个标签候选项之后,所述用户可以针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的其中一个标签候选项触发选择操作,若所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第一标签触发了选择操作,例如点击了所述第一标签,则所述客户端可以获取所述第一标签,并进一步保存所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系。
需要说明的是,考虑到标签可以具备使用权限,只有当用户具备某一标签的使用权限时,所述用户才能为信息添加该标签。因此,在一个示例中,所述至少一个标签候选项,可以是所述用户具备使用权限的候选项。
如前所述,所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的任务的信息。在一个示例中,考虑到对于任务而言,可能随着时间的推移,其具备的标签可能会发生变化。例如,任务A原本与项目1和项目2关联,但是,随着项目的进展情况,任务A不再与项目1关联。此时,任务A不再适合具备相关1对应的标签(例如第一标签)。
考虑到这种情况,在本申请实施例中,所述用户可以在所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面中触发的标签取消操作,相应的,客户端可以响应于所述标签取消操作,以删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系。可以理解的是,删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系之后,所述第一标签的概览页面不再呈现所述第一任务的信息,相应的,所述第一标签的任务信息域对应 的页面中,也不再呈现所述第一任务的信息。
可以理解的是,若所述第一任务仅具备第一标签这一个标签,则删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系之后,若对前述第一页面进行刷新,则刷新后的所述第一页面中也不再包括所述第一任务的信息。若所述第一任务除了包括第一标签之外,还包括其它标签,则删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系之后,若对前述第一页面进行刷新,则刷新后的所述第一页面中可以包括所述第一任务的信息,只是所述第一任务的标签,不再包括所述第一标签。
本申请实施例还提供了一种信息处理方法,以下结合附图介绍该方法。
参见图14,该图为本申请实施例提供的一种信息处理方法的流程示意图。
与图12所示的基于任务的信息处理方法类似,图14所示的信息处理方法,也可以由客户端执行。图14所示的日程创建方法例如可以包括如下S1401-S1403。
S1401:响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域。
在本申请实施例中,所述用户可以在其客户端显示的页面上触发针对第一信息域的信息添加操作。例如,所述客户端显示的页面中可以包括第一控件,该第一控件用于触发针对第一信息域的信息添加操作。所述用户例如可以通过点击该第一控件来触发针对所述第一信息域的信息添加操作。
在一个示例中,所述用户可以在第一标签的概览页面中触发针对第一信息域的信息添加操作。关于所述第一标签的概览页面,可以参考上文的相关描述部分,此处不再重复描述。
在本申请实施例中,所述用户触发针对所述第一信息域的信息添加操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面。该第一信息添加页面中可以包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域,至少包括第一信息域和第二信息域。
其中:第一信息域和第二信息域可以是不同的信息域。所述第一信息域可以是任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组中的其中一项,所述第二信息域也可以是任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组中的其中一项。例如,所述第一信息域为日程,所述第二信息域为云文档;又如,所述第一信息域为任务,所 述第二信息域为云文档;等等,此处不一一列举说明。
在一个示例中,所述客户端响应于针对所述第一信息域的信息添加操作所呈现的第一信息添加页面中,除了包括所述多个信息域的标识之外,还默认呈现对应所述第一信息域的至少一个候选信息,以便于所述第一用户对对应所述第一信息域的至少一个候选信息中的一个或者多个候选信息触发选择操作,从而实现添加一个或者多个对应所述第一信息域的信息的目的。需要说明的是,在一个示例中,对应所述第一信息域的至少一个候选信息,为所述用户具备查看权限的信息。
S1402:响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应的第二信息域的候选信息,所述第二信息域与所述第一信息域不同。
S1403:响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
在本申请实施例中,所述第一信息添加页面中包括第二信息域的标识,若所述用户希望添加对应第二信息域的信息,则所述用户可以针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作。所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作之后,所述客户端可以向响应于所述用户针对第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应于所述第二信息域的候选信息。需要说明的是,在一个示例中,对应所述第二信息域的候选信息,为所述用户具备查看权限的信息。
而后,所述用户可以针对所述第二信息域的候选信息中的至少一个信息触发选择操作,这样一来,所述客户端即可响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的候选信息中的至少一个信息触发选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的对应关系。至此,即完成了添加对应第二信息域的至少一个信息的目的。
由此可见,利用本方案,即使用户触发了针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,也可以添加具备第一标签的、第二信息域的信息。这样一来,所述客户端显示的页面例如第一标签的概览页面中可以无需包括用于触发针对各个信息域的信息添加操作的控件,而是包括第一控件即可,这样一来,可以减少所述客户端显示的页面包括的控件数量,使得所述客户端显示的页面的布局更加简明。
关于图14所示的方法,现以所述客户端显示的页面为第一标签的概览页面为例,结合图15a至图15c进行说明。图15a为本申请实施例提供的一种第 一标签的概览页面的示意图,图15b为本申请实施例提供的一种信息添加页面的示意图,图15c为本申请实施例提供的又一种信息添加页面的示意图。
如图15a所示,第一标签“M”的概览页面中,包括具备第一标签的各个信息域的信息。其中,第一信息域可以为日程,所述用户可以通过图15a所示的控件“立即添加”触发针对日程的信息添加操作。用户触发针对日程的信息添加操作之后,所述客户端可以显示图15b所示的信息添加页面,该信息添加页面中包括各个信息域的标识(即图15b所示的各个信息域的名称)、以及对应日程的信息候选项:日程A至日程E。用户针对第二信息域例如“云文档”的标识触发选择操作,例如用户点击图15b的“云文档”之后,所述客户端可以显示图15c所示的信息添加页面。图15c所示的信息添加页面中包括对应云文档的信息候选项:云文档1至云文档5。若用户针对云文档1触发了选择操作,则所述客户端可以生成标签M和云文档1的对应关系。
需要说明的是,执行以上S1401-S1403之后,所述客户端还可以在所述第一标签的、所述第二信息域对应的页面中,显示所述至少一个信息。其中,所述第一标签的、所述第二信息域对应的页面,用于呈现具备所述第一标签、且对应于第二信息域的信息。例如,所述第二信息域为云文档,则所述第一标签的、所述第二信息域对应的页面,用于呈现具备第一标签的云文档。在一个示例中,在第一用户的客户端上,所述第一标签的、所述第二信息域对应的页面,用于呈现具备所述第一标签、对应于第二信息域、且所述第一用户具备查看权限的信息。
在一个示例中,所述用户还可以在第一标签的概览页面中触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,从而实现添加具备第一标签的与第一信息域对应的信息的目的。具体地:
所述用户在所述第一标签的概览页面中触发针对第一信息域的信息添加操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述信息添加操作,显示第二信息添加页面。其中,所述第二信息添加页面中例如可以包括用于编辑对应第一信息域的信息的编辑区域。显示第二信息添加页面之后,所述用户可以在所述第二信息添加页面中的编辑区域编辑对应第一信息域的信息。例如,所述用户可以在所述第二信息添加页面中的编辑区域编辑第一信息。这样一来,所述客户端即可获取所述第一信息,并进一步生成所述第一信息和所述第一标签的对应关系。
所述客户端生成所述第一信息和所述第一标签的对应关系之后,所述客户端还可以在所述第一标签的概览页面中显示所述第一信息。例如,可以在所述概览页面中所述第一信息域对应的显示区域中显示所述第一信息。另外,所述客户端还可以在所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面中,显示所述第一信息。其中,所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面,用于呈现具备所述第一标签、且对应于第一信息域的信息。在一个示例中,若所述用户为所述第一标签的所有者,则所述用户还可以在所述第一标签的概览页面中,触发协作者编辑操作,以对所述第一标签的协作者进行编辑。其中,第一标签的协作者,指的是具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户。若用户具备第一标签的查看权限,则该用户具备查看所述第一标签的关联信息的权限。第一标签的关联信息,指的是具备第一标签的各个信息域的信息。
在本申请实施例中,所述用户触发所述协作者编辑操作之后,所述客户端则可以响应于所述协作者编辑操作,获取编辑后的协作者的信息,并生成所述编辑后的协作者与所述第一标签的对应关系。
此处提及的协作者编辑操作,可以包括三种操作,分别为协作者增加操作、协作者删除操作以及协作者修改操作。其中,协作者增加操作用于在原有协作者的基础上增加新的协作者;协作者删除操作用于删除原有协作者中的部分或者全部协作者;协作者修改操作用于对原有协作者中的部分或者全部协作者进行修改,例如将第一协作者修改为第二协作者。
需要说明的是,用户在所述概览页面中触发的协作者编辑操作在具体实现时,可以有多种实现方式。在一个示例中,所述概览页面中可以包括一个协作者编辑控件,用户触发该控件之后,客户端显示协作者编辑页面,用户可以在该协作者编辑页面中触发协作者增加操作、协作者删除操作以及协作者修改操作中的其中一种或者多种操作。在又一个示例中,所述概览页面中可以包括多个控件,分别为协作者增加控件、协作者删除控件和协作者修改控件。用户可以通过所述协作者增加控件触发协作者增加操作,用户可以通过所述协作者删除控件触发协作者删除操作,用户可以通过所述协作者修改控件触发协作者修改操作。
如前文,所述第一标签的概览页面为对具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息分区域显示的页面。在一个示例中,所述第一标签的概览页面中,显示有 各信息域中、具有所述第一标签的信息数量。可参考图15a进行理解,图15a示出了任务信息域对应的任务数量为3、云文档信息域对应的云文档数量为5、消息信息域对应的消息数量为1、群组信息域对应的群组数量为1、日程信息域对应的日程数量为1。
考虑到概览页面能够呈现的内容有限,对于所述各个信息域中的第一信息域而言,概览页面中可能并不能完全显示各个信息。为方便用户查看所述第一信息域中的具体信息。若所述用户希望查看所述第一信息域中的具体信息,可以针对所述第一信息域对应的信息数量触发的预设操作,例如点击所述第一信息域对应的信息数量。这样一来,所述客户端即可响应于所述用户针对所述第一信息域对应的信息数量触发的预设操作,显示所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面,以便于所述用户查看所述第一信息域的具体信息。
在一个示例中,若用户希望查看所述概览页面中的某一信息例如第二信息,则所述用户可以在所述概览页面中针对第二信息触发预设操作,例如点击所述概览页面中所显示的第二信息的信息摘要,以实现对第二信息的查看。
在一些实施例中,所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作,跳转至包括所述第二信息的页面。这样一来,所述用户即可查看所述第二信息。例如,所述第二信息为群组,则所述客户端可以跳转至所述群组所在的页面。又如,所述第二信息为消息,则客户端可以跳转至所述消息所在的即时会话页面。再如,所述第二信息为日程,则所述客户端可以跳转至所述日程所在的页面。
在又一些实施例中,所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作,显示所述第二信息。此处提及的第二信息,指的是所述用户具备查看权限的信息。作为一个示例,可以在浏览器中显示所述第二信息。作为一个示例,可以在所述概览页面中的第一区域(例如侧边栏)显示所述第二信息。本申请实施例不具体限定所述第二信息,所述第二信息可以是任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组中的任意一种。在一个示例中,若所述第二信息为即时通信消息,则所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作之后,所述客户端除了显示所述第二信息本身之外,还可以显示所述第二信息的 上下文信息,以便于用户查看所述第二信息以及所述第二信息的上下文信息。
需要说明的是,当所述第二信息为群组时,在所述概览页面的第一区域显示所述第二信息在具体实现时,例如可以显示所述群组的摘要信息(例如名称)。又如可以在所述第一区域显示所述群组对应的即时会话界面。
若所述客户端在所述概览页面的第一区域显示了所述群组对应的即时会话界面,则当所述用户为所述群组中的用户时,所述用户可以在所述第一区域进行即时通信会话,而无需跳转至所述群组所在的即时会话界面。具体地,所述用户可以在所述第一区域输入即时会话消息,所述客户端接收到所述用户输入的即时会话消息之后,可以在所述即时会话界面中显示所述即时会话消息。另外,若所述群组中的其它用户在所述群组中发布了即时会话消息,所述客户端还可以在所述第一区域显示所述其它用户发布的即时会话消息。
在一些实施例中,若所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作之后,所述客户端跳转至包括所述第二信息的页面。则为了使得所述客户端显示的页面快速的由包括所述第二信息的页面切换为所述概览页面,所述用户还可以在包括所述第二信息的页面中触发的预设操作,相应的,所述客户端可以响应于所述用户在包括所述第二信息的页面中触发的预设操作,显示所述概览页面。从而快速的将所述客户端显示的页面切换为所述概览页面。在一个示例中,所述包括所述第二信息的页面中还可以包括第二控件,所述用户在包括所述第二信息的页面中触发的预设操作,例如可以是点击了所述第二控件。
基于以上实施例提供的方法,本申请实施例还提供了对应的装置,以下结合附图介绍该装置。
参见图16,该图为本申请实施例提供的一种基于任务的信息处理装置的结构示意图。所述装置1600例如可以具体包括:第一获取单元1601和第一显示单元1602。
第一获取单元1601,用于获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务,所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享;
第一显示单元1602,用于在第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,所述第一页面为:登录所述第一用户的账户的客户端上显示的页面。
可选的,所述与第一用户相关的任务,包括以下任意一项或者多项:
创建者为所述第一用户的任务、执行者为所述第一用户的任务、以及所述第一用户关注的任务。
可选的,所述至少一个任务包括第一任务,所述第一任务的信息,包括以下任意一项或者多项:
所述第一任务所具备的标签、所述第一任务的创建者、所述第一任务的执行者、所述第一任务的截止日期、所述第一任务的状态以及所述第一任务的摘要信息。
可选的,所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,以列表形式在所述第一页面中显示,一个任务的信息对应所述列表中的一条记录,所述列表的表头用于指示所述每个任务的信息所包括的内容。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第一确定单元,用于响应于所述第一用户针对所述表头触发的任务信息选择操作,确定所述第一页面上显示的所述每个任务的信息所包括的内容。
可选的,所述至少一个任务中的每个任务的信息的排列顺序为:所述至少一个任务中每个任务的截止日期由近到远的顺序。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
修改单元,用于响应于第一用户针对所述至少一个任务中的第一任务触发的位置移动操作,修改所述第一任务在所述第一页面中的显示位置。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第二获取单元,用于响应于所述第一用户触发的任务筛选操作,获取至少一个维度的筛选条件;
第二确定单元,用于从所述至少一个任务中确定符合所述筛选条件的任务;
第二显示单元,用于显示筛选得到的所述任务的信息。
可选的,所述至少一个维度,包括:
标签、创建者、执行者、截止日期、以及状态。
可选的,所述至少一个任务包括:具备第一标签的第一任务,所述装置还包括创建单元,用于:
响应于用户在所述第一标签的概览页面中触发的任务创建操作,创建所述第一任务,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个 信息域的信息;或者,
响应于用户在所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面中触发的任务创建操作,创建所述第一任务,所述任务信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的任务的信息。
可选的,所述至少一个任务包括:具备第一标签的第一任务,所述装置还包括:
第三获取单元,用于响应于用户在第一任务对应的页面中触发的标签添加操作,获取所述标签添加操作对应的所述第一标签;
保存单元,用于保存所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系。
可选的,所述至少一个任务包括:具备第一标签的第一任务,所述装置还包括:
删除单元,用于响应于用户在所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面中触发的标签取消操作,删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系,删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系之后,所述第一标签的概览页面和所述任务信息域对应的页面中,不包括所述第一任务。
关于所述装置1600的各个单元所对应的功能的具体实现,可以参考上文对于图12所示的方法的描述部分,此处不再重复描述。
参见图17,该图为本申请实施例提供的一种信息处理装置的结构示意图。所述装置600例如可以具体包括:第一显示单元1701、第二显示单元1702和第一生成单元1703。
第一显示单元1701,用于响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域;
第二显示单元1702,用于响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应第二信息域的候选信息,所述第二信息域与所述第一信息域不同;
第一生成单元1703,用于响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
可选的,所述响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,包括:
响应于所述用户在第一标签的概览页面中触发的针对所述第一信息域的 信息添加操作,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息。
可选的,响应于针对所述第一信息域的信息添加操作所呈现的第一信息添加页面中,还默认呈现对应所述第一信息域的候选信息。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第三显示单元,用于在所述第一标签的、所述第二信息域对应的页面中,显示所述至少一个信息。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第四显示单元,用于响应于所述用户在第一标签的概览页面中触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第二信息添加页面,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息;
第一获取单元,用于获取所述用户在所述第二信息添加页面中添加的与所述第一信息域对应的第一信息;
第二生成单元,用于生成所述第一信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第五显示单元,用于在所述概览页面中显示所述第一信息,以及,
第六显示单元,用于在所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面中显示所述第一信息。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第二获取单元,用于响应于所述用户在所述概览页面中触发的协作者编辑操作,获取编辑后的协作者的信息,生成所述编辑后的协作者与所述第一标签的对应关系。
可选的,所述协作者修改操作,包括:
协作者增加操作,或者,协作者删除操作,或者,协作者修改操作;其中,所述协作者修改操作用于将第一协作者修改为第二协作者。
可选的,所述第一标签的概览页面中显示有各信息域中,具有所述第一标签的信息数量,所述各个信息域包括所述第一信息域;所述装置还包括:
第七显示单元,用于响应于所述用户针对所述第一信息域对应的信息数量触发的预设操作,显示所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面,所述第一信息域对应的页面中包括具备所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的信息 的信息摘要。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
跳转单元,用于响应于所述用户针对第一标签的概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作,跳转至包括所述第二信息的页面;或者,
第八显示单元,用于响应于所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作,显示所述第二信息,其中,所述用户具备所述第二信息的查看权限;
所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息。
可选的,所述第二信息为即时通信消息,所述装置还包括:
呈现单元,用于呈现所述第二信息的上下文信息。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第九显示单元,用于响应于所述用户在包括所述第二信息的页面中触发的预设操作,显示所述概览页面。
可选的,所述第二信息为群组,所述第八显示单元,用于:
在所述概览页面中的第一区域显示所述群组对应的即时会话界面。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
接收单元,用于接收所述用户在所述第一区域输入的即时会话消息,所述用户为所述群组中包括的用户;
第十显示单元,用于在所述即时会话界面中显示所述即时会话消息。
可选的,
所述第一信息域为以下任意一项:任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组;
所述第二信息域为以下任意一项:任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组。
关于所述装置1700的各个单元所对应的功能的具体实现,可以参考上文对于图14所示的方法的描述部分,此处不再重复描述。
本申请实施例还提供了一种设备,所述设备包括处理器和存储器;所述处理器用于执行所述存储器中存储的指令,以使得所述设备执行以上方法实施例提供的基于任务的信息处理或者信息处理方法。
本申请实施例还提供了一种计算机可读存储介质,包括指令,所述指令指示设备执行以上方法实施例提供的基于任务的信息处理方法或者信息处理方 法。
申请实施例还提供了一种计算机程序产品,当所述计算机程序产品在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行以上方法实施例提供的基于任务的信息处理方法或者信息处理方法。
在一些场景中,需要创建具备标签的日程。例如,对于某一项目而言,对于与该项目相关的日程,可以为该日程添加标签。该项目的参与者可以通过该标签定位到与该项目相关的日程,以便于项目的参与者合理安排工作日程。但是,目前创建具备标签的日程的方式,用户操作比较繁琐。例如,对于某一项目而言,对于与该项目相关的日程,可以为该日程添加标签。在一个示例中,可以为与该日程相关的项目参与者赋予该标签的权限,并为与该日程相关的项目参与者赋予所述日程的访问权限。这样一来,与该日程相关的项目参与者可以通过该标签定位到该日程,从而合理安排工作日程。
但是,目前创建具备标签的日程的方式,用户操作比较繁琐。作为一个示例,首先需要创建一个日程,而后,为该日程添加对应的标签。
为了解决上述问题,本申请实施例提供了一种日程创建方法及装置。
下面结合附图,详细说明本申请的各种非限制性实施方式。
参见图18,该图为本申请实施例提供的一种日程创建方法的流程示意图。
本申请实施例提供的方法,可以由客户端,也可以由服务端执行,在本申请实施例中,所述客户端上可以安装有目标应用程序,所述服务端可以是所述目标应用程序对应的服务端。本申请实施例中提及的用户,指的是在客户端上登录所述目标应用程序的账号所对应的用户。
在本申请实施例的以下描述中,以所述方法由客户端执行为例进行说明。
本申请实施例附图中的“#”为标签识别符,当然,标签识别符不限于“#”,也可以是其它符号。
在不冲突的情况下,以下图18所示的方法和图20所示的方法,可以相互结合和引用。
本申请实施例中的所有附图,例如图19,其只是为了方便理解与本申请实施例相关的内容而示出,其并不构成对本申请实施例的限定。图19所示的页面中也可以还包括其它内容,本申请实施例不具体限定。
在本实施例中,图18所示的方法例如可以包括以下步骤:S1801-S1802。
S1801:响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息。
在本申请实施例中,第一标签的关联信息,指的是与第一标签具备关联关系的信息。此处提及的信息,包括但不限于任务、日程、消息、云文档以及群组等中的其中一种或者多种。其中,任务、日程、消息、云文档以及群组可以各自对应一个信息域,具体地:任务可以对应任务信息域,日程可以对应日程信息域,消息可以对应消息信息域,云文档可以对应云文档信息域,群组可以对应群组信息域。本申请实施例中的信息域,用于提供某一类型的信息。在一些应用场景中,一个信息域可以对应一个服务提供方。
在本申请实施例的一种实现方式中,所述第一标签的关联页面,可以是所述第一标签的概览页面,所述第一标签的概览页面为对具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息进行汇总显示的页面。在一个示例中,所述第一标签的概览页面中,可以包括具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息,例如,包括任务信息域的信息、日程信息域的信息、消息信息域的信息、云文档信息域的信息以及群组信息域的信息中的其中一种或者多种。在一些实施例中,为方便用户查看所述概览页中包括的信息,所述各个信息域对应的信息,在所述概览页面中分区域呈现。例如,在所述概览页中,所述任务信息域、日程信息域、消息信息域、云文档信息域以及群组信息域各自对应一个显示区域,用于显示与自身对应的信息。即:任务信息域对应的显示区域用于显示具备第一标签的任务的信息;日程信息域对应的显示区域用于显示具备第一标签的日程的信息;消息信息域对应的显示区域用于显示具备第一标签的消息的信息;云文档信息域对应的显示区域用于显示具备第一标签的云文档的信息;群组信息域对应的显示区域用于显示具备第一标签的群组的信息。
在本申请实施例的又一种实现方式中,所述第一标签的关联页面,可以是所述第一标签的日程信息域对应的页面,所述第一标签的日程信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的日程的信息。其中,所述日程信息域对应的页面,也可以被称为“日程页面”。
在一个示例中,所述用户的客户端上显示的第一标签的关联页面,所呈现的内容为所述用户具备查看权限的内容。
在本申请实施例的一种实现方式中,所述第一标签的关联页面中,可以包括第一控件,所述第一控件对应的功能为日程添加功能。所述用户可以通过所述第一控件触发日程添加操作。所述用户触发日程添加操作之后,所述客户端可以显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中可以自动带入所述第一标签。
在一个示例中,S1801在具体实现时,所述客户端例如可以首先调用日程应用程序编程接口(Application Programming Interface,API),并将所述第一标签作为参数通过所述日程API传递给日程应用程序,从而得到前述包括第一标签的日程添加页面。其中,日程应用程序为用于创建日程的软件模块。
S1802:获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,生成具备所述第一标签的日程。
显示所述日程添加页面之后,用户可以在所述日程添加页面中输入日程信息,例如,输入日程的主题,日程的起始时间和结束时间、以及对应的会议室等详情信息。
用户在所述日程添加页面中输入日程信息之后,所述客户端可以获取所述用户输入的日程信息,并进一步根据所获取的日程信息生成具备所述第一标签的日程。可以理解的是,所生成的日程包括所述客户端获取的日程信息。
通过以上描述可知,利用图18所示的日程创建方法,用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发日程添加操作之后,日程添加页面中会自动带入第一标签,进一步地,可以生成包括所述第一标签的日程。无需用户首先创建日程,再为日程添加第一标签,从而降低了创建具备标签的日程的操作繁琐性。
在一个示例中,创建具备所述第一标签的日程之后,所述第一标签的日程页面中,可以呈现该日程的摘要信息。此处提及的日程的摘要信息,例如可以是该日程的主题,又如可以是该日程的主题中的关键词,此处不做限定。其中,所述第一标签对应的日程页面,用于显示具备所述第二标签的日程的摘要信息。在一些实施例中,所述客户端上显示的所述第一标签对应的日程页面中,可以显示所述用户具备查看权限的日程的摘要信息。
在一个示例中,对于一个日程而言,可以为其添加多个标签。对于这种情况,所述用户还可以在所述日程添加页面中触发标签编辑操作。例如,所述日程添加页面中包括标签添加控件,所述用户可以通过所述标签添加控件触发所述标签编辑操作。所述用户触发所述标签编辑操作之后,所述客户端可以获取 所述标签编辑操作所指示的第二标签,相应的,所述客户端所生成的日程,除了包括前述第一标签之外,还可以包括第二标签。
可以理解的是,若所述日程还具备第二标签,则所述第二标签的日程页面中,可以呈现该日程的摘要信息。其中,所述第二标签对应的日程页面,用于显示具备所述第二标签的日程的摘要信息。在一些实施例中,所述客户端上显示的所述第二标签对应的日程页面中,可以显示所述用户具备查看权限的日程的摘要信息。
在本申请实施例中,“响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取第二标签”在具体实现时,可以有多种实现方式。以下介绍两种可能的实现方式。
第一种实现方式:
所述用户在日程添加页面中触发标签编辑操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于该标签编辑操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,显示所述至少一个标签候选项之后,所述用户可以针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的其中一个标签候选项触发选择操作,若所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发了选择操作,例如点击了所述第二标签,则所述客户端可以获取所述第二标签。
需要说明的是,考虑到标签可以具备使用权限,只有当用户具备某一标签的使用权限时,所述用户才能为信息添加该标签。因此,在一个示例中,所述至少一个标签候选项,可以是所述用户具备使用权限的候选项。
第二种实现方式:
所述用户在日程添加页面中触发标签编辑操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于该标签编辑操作,显示字符输入区。而后,所述用户可以在所述字符输入区输入字符。用户可以在该字符输入区输入第二标签所包括的至少一部分字符。相应的,客户端获取到所述用户输入的字符之后,可以根据所述用户输入的字符,为所述用户提供对应的标签候选项,并显示所述标签候选项,以便于用户基于所述标签候选项选择所述第二标签。当所述用户选择所述第二标签之后,即所述用户针对所述标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发了选择操作,例如点击了所述第二标签之后,则所述客户端可以获取所述第二标签。
在一些实施例中,考虑到日程一般具备对应的参与者。而第一标签本身也可能具备一定的标识含义,例如,与某一项目相关。相应的,第一标签也具备 一定的协作者,所谓第一标签的协作者,指的是具备第一标签权限的用户。例如,是具备第一标签查看权限的用户。其中,具备第一标签查看权限的用户,具备查看第一标签的关联信息的权限。由于该日程具备第一标签,因此,在一些场景中,可以默认该第一标签的协作者也可以同时作为所述日程的参与者。因此,在一个示例中,前述日程添加页面中,还可以包括所述日程的参与者,且所述日程的参与者为具备所述第一标签的权限的用户。换言之,所述日程添加页面中可以自动带入所述第一标签的协作者。这样一来,可以无需用户手动输入所述日程的参与者,提升创建该日程的效率。
在又一些实施例中,所述日程的参与者也可以由用户指定。对于这种情况,所述用户可以在所述日程添加页面中输入所述日程的参与者。
需要说明的是,所述用户输入的所述日程的参与者,可以包括所述第一标签的协作者,也可以包括所述第一标签的协作者之外的其它用户。在一些应用场景中,若所述用户输入的所述日程的参与者包括第一标签的协作者之外的其它用户,则生成具备所述第一标签的日程之后,可以将日程的参与者中,所述第一标签的协作者之外的其它用户则转变为所述第一标签的协作者。换言之,生成具备所述第一标签的日程之后,所述客户端可以响应于具备所述第一标签的日程的生成,赋予所述日程的参与者所述第一标签的权限。具体地:可以赋予所述日程的参与者中原本不具备所述第一标签的权限的用户所述第一标签的权限。此处提及的第一标签的权限,可以是所述第一标签的查看权限。所谓第一标签的查看权限,指的是查看所述第一标签的关联信息的权限,例如,用于指示用户所使用的客户端是否能够关联地显示第一标签和具有该第一标签的至少一部分信息的权限。此处提及的第一标签的关联信息,指的是具备第一标签的信息。
举例说明,用户输入了该日程的参与者包括用户A和用户B,其中,用户B不是第一标签的协作者,则生成所述日程之后,可以赋予用户B所述第一标签的查看权限,使得用户B成为所述第一标签的协作者。采用这种方式,无需用户首先将用户B修改为第一标签的协作者,再将用户B设置为所述日程的参与者,所述用户可以直接将用户B设置为所述日程的参与者,操作灵活,简化用户操作从而改善用户体验。进一步地,在第一标签对应某一多人协作的项目的场景下,对于具备所述日程的查看权限的用户B,即使该成员当前不具备 第一标签的查看权限,例如,所述用户B为新加入该项目的用户。采用这种方式,也可以快速将用户B设置为所述日程的参与者,并将该用户B自动设置为第一标签的协作者,而无需额外将用户B设置为第一标签的协作者,操作灵活,用户体验高。
关于所述日程添加页面,现结合图19进行说明。图19为本申请实施例提供的一种日程添加页面的示意图。
如图19所示,#A代表第一标签,“ 添加标签”为标签添加控件。标签的参与者,如上所述,可以是第一标签的协作者,也可以是用户输入的,例如可以在图19中指示“参与者”的区域中以“***”表示。对于标签详情中的其它内容,例如对应的会议室,日程提醒方式等,例如可以在图19中指示“日程详情”的区域中以“*****”表示。当用户在日程添加页面中输入日程信息之后,可以点击图19所示的“保存”控件,以生成该包括第一标签的日程。
需要说明的是,在本申请实施例中,所述第一标签不是仅能够在所述用户的客户端本地使用的标签,而是可以在一定范围内共享的标签。具体地,所述第一标签的共享范围,可以由所述第一标签的权限确定。
在一个示例中,所述第一标签的权限,可以包括使用权限。所谓使用权限,指的是为信息单元添加第一标签的权限。具体地,具备所述第一标签的使用权限的用户,均可以在其对应的客户端上为信息单元添加所述第一标签。其中,所述第一标签的使用权限,可以由所述第一标签的所有者设置,第一标签的所有者可以指定具备所述第一标签的使用权限的用户。
在又一个示例中,所述第一标签的权限,包括查看权限。所谓查看权限,指的是查看所述第一标签的关联信息的权限。具体地:具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户的客户端上,显示所述第一标签的关联信息。换言之,具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户,可以在其对应的客户端查看第一标签的关联信息。其中,所述第一标签的查看权限,可以由所述第一标签的所有者设置,第一标签的所有者可以指定具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户。
在一些实施例中,考虑到信息单元本身也具备查看权限。则对于具备第一标签的查看权限的第一用户而言,所述第一用户的客户端上呈现的第一标签的关联信息,可以是所述第一用户具备查看权限的信息。换言之,所述第一用户的客户端上呈现的第一标签的关联信息,不包括所述第一用户不具备查看权限 的信息。这样一来,可以有效保护信息安全,避免所述第一用户查看其不具备查看权限的信息而导致信息泄露。在一个示例中,对于第一用户具备查看权限的第一信息单元而言,若所述第一信息单元具备第一标签,则所述第一用户的客户端上,可以关联呈现所述第一标签和第一信息单元。这样一来,所述第一用户即可根据该关联呈现的所述第一标签和第一信息单元,确定第一信息单元的具体内容,并确定所述第一信息单元具备所述第一标签。
本申请实施例还提供了一种日程创建方法,接下来结合附图介绍该方法。
参见图20,该图为本申请实施例提供的又一种日程创建方法的流程示意图。
与图18所示的日程创建方法类似,图20所示的日程创建方法,也可以由客户端或者服务端执行。在本申请实施例的以下描述中,以所述方法由客户端执行为例进行说明。
图20所示的日程创建方法例如可以包括如下S2001-S2003。
S2001:响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息。
关于S2001,可以参考上文对于S1801的描述部分,此处不做重复描述。
S2002:响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签。
在本申请实施例中,考虑到当客户端上显示的页面为第一标签的关联页面时,用户可能也具备创建具备第二标签的日程的需求。因此,在一个示例中,用户可以在所述第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,而后,所述客户端可以显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签。并且,所述第一标签是可以修改的。具体地:用户可以通过触发标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签。
S2002在具体实现时,可以有多种实现方式,以下介绍两种可能的实现方式。
第一种实现方式:
所述用户在日程添加页面中触发标签编辑操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于该标签编辑操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,显示所述至少一个标签候选项 之后,所述用户可以针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的其中一个标签候选项触发选择操作,若所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发了选择操作,例如点击了所述第二标签,则所述客户端可以将所述第一标签修改为所述第二标签。
需要说明的是,考虑到标签可以具备使用权限,只有当用户具备某一标签的使用权限时,所述用户才能为信息添加该标签。因此,在一个示例中,所述至少一个标签候选项,可以是所述用户具备使用权限的候选项。
第二种实现方式:
所述用户在日程添加页面中触发标签编辑操作之后,所述客户端可以响应于该标签编辑操作,显示字符输入区。而后,所述用户可以在所述字符输入区输入字符。用户可以在该字符输入区输入第二标签所包括的至少一部分字符。相应的,客户端获取到所述用户输入的字符之后,可以根据所述用户输入的字符,为所述用户提供对应的标签候选项,并显示所述标签候选项,以便于用户基于所述标签候选项选择所述第二标签。当所述用户选择所述第二标签之后,即所述用户针对所述标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发了选择操作,例如点击了所述第二标签,则所述客户端可以将所述第一标签修改为所述第二标签。
S2003:获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,生成具备所述第二标签的日程。
显示所述日程添加页面之后,用户除了可以触发标签编辑操作之外,还可以在所述日程添加页面中输入日程信息,例如,输入日程的主题,日程的起始时间和结束时间、以及对应的会议室等详情信息。
用户在所述日程添加页面中输入日程信息之后,所述客户端可以获取所述用户输入的日程信息,并进一步根据所获取的日程信息生成具备所述第二标签的日程。可以理解的是,所生成的日程包括所述客户端获取的日程信息。
在一个示例中,创建具备所述第二标签的日程之后,所述第二标签的日程页面中,可以呈现该日程的摘要信息。
通过以上描述可知,利用图20所示的日程创建方法,当用户希望创建具备第二标签的日程时,即使客户端显示的页面为第一标签的关联页面,用户也无需将客户端显示的页面切换为第二标签的关联页面,而是可以在第一标签的关联页面中直接创建具备第二标签的日程,从而提升了创建具备标签的日程的 操作灵活性。
基于以上实施例提供的方法,本申请实施例还提供了一种装置,以下结合附图介绍该装置。
参见图21,该图为本申请实施例提供的一种日程创建装置的结构示意图。所述装置2100例如可以具体包括:显示单元2101、第一获取单元2102和生成单元2103。
显示单元2101,用于响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
第一获取单元2102,用于获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息;
生成单元2103,用于生成具备所述第一标签的日程。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第二获取单元,用于响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取标签编辑操作所指示的第二标签;
所述生成单元2103,用于:
生成具备所述第一标签和所述第二标签的日程。
可选的,所述用户通过标签添加控件触发所述标签编辑操作。
可选的,所述第二获取单元,用于:
响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,所述至少一个标签候选项包括所述第二标签;
响应于所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发的选择操作,获取所述第二标签。
可选的,所述第二获取单元,用于:
响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取用户输入的字符,根据所述用户输入的字符获取所述第二标签。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第一显示单元,用于在所述第二标签对应的日程页面中,显示所述日程的摘要信息,所述第二标签对应的日程页面,用于显示具备所述第二标签的日程的摘要信息。
可选的,所述日程添加页面中还包括:所述日程的参与者,所述日程的参与者为具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户。
可选的,所述第一获取单元2102,用于:
获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的所述日程的参与者。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
权限设置单元,用于:若在生成具备所述第一标签的日程之前,所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的所述日程的参与者,不具备所述第一标签的权限,则响应于具备所述第一标签的日程的生成,赋予所述日程的参与者所述第一标签的权限。
可选的,所述第一标签在具备所述第一标签的权限的用户间共享。
可选的,所述第一标签的权限,包括使用权限,具备所述第一标签的使用权限的用户,具备在其对应的客户端上为信息单元添加所述第一标签的权限。
可选的,所述第一标签的权限,包括查看权限,具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户的客户端上,显示所述第一标签的关联信息。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第二显示单元,用于响应于第一用户具备所述第一标签的查看权限,在所述第一用户的客户端上,关联呈现所述第一标签和第一信息单元,其中,所述第一信息单元为所述第一用户具备查看权限的信息单元。
可选的,所述第一标签的关联页面,包括:
所述第一标签的概览页面,或者,所述第一标签的日程信息域对应的页面;其中:
所述概览页面为对具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息进行汇总显示的页面;或者,所述日程信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的日程的信息。
可选的,所述各个信息域对应的信息,在所述概览页面中分区域呈现。
由于所述装置2100是与以上方法实施例提供的与图18对应的方法对应的装置,所述装置2100的各个单元的具体实现,均与以上方法实施例中图18所示的方法为同一构思,因此,关于所述装置2100的各个单元的具体实现,可以参考以上方法实施例的相关描述部分,此处不再赘述。
参见图22,该图为本申请实施例提供的又一种日程创建装置的结构示意 图。所述装置2200例如可以具体包括:第一显示单元2201、修改单元2202、获取单元2203和生成单元2204。
第一显示单元2201,用于响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
修改单元2202,用于响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签;
获取单元2203,用于获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息;
生成单元2204,用于生成具备所述第二标签的日程。
可选的,所述修改单元2202,用于:
响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,所述至少一个标签候选项包括所述第二标签;
响应于所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发的选择操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签。
可选的,所述修改单元2202,用于:
响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取用户输入的字符,根据所述用户输入的字符获取所述第二标签,并将所述第一标签修改为第二标签。
可选的,所述装置还包括:
第二显示单元,用于在所述第二标签对应的日程页面中,显示所述日程的摘要信息,所述第二标签对应的日程页面,用于显示具备所述第二标签的日程的摘要信息。
由于所述装置2200是与以上方法实施例提供的与图20对应的方法对应的装置,所述装置2200的各个单元的具体实现,均与以上方法实施例中图20所示的方法为同一构思,因此,关于所述装置2200的各个单元的具体实现,可以参考以上方法实施例的相关描述部分,此处不再赘述。
本申请实施例还提供了一种设备,所述设备包括处理器和存储器;所述处理器用于执行所述存储器中存储的指令,以使得所述设备执行以上方法实施例提供的日程创建方法。
本申请实施例还提供了一种计算机可读存储介质,包括指令,所述指令指示设备执行以上方法实施例提供的日程创建方法。
申请实施例还提供了一种计算机程序产品,当所述计算机程序产品在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行以上方法实施例提供的日程创建方法。
以上描述仅为本公开的较佳实施例以及对所运用技术原理的说明。本领域技术人员应当理解,本公开中所涉及的公开范围,并不限于上述技术特征的特定组合而成的技术方案,同时也应涵盖在不脱离上述公开构思的情况下,由上述技术特征或其等同特征进行任意组合而形成的其它技术方案。例如上述特征与本公开中公开的(但不限于)具有类似功能的技术特征进行互相替换而形成的技术方案。
此外,虽然采用特定次序描绘了各操作,但是这不应当理解为要求这些操作以所示出的特定次序或以顺序次序执行来执行。在一定环境下,多任务和并行处理可能是有利的。同样地,虽然在上面论述中包含了若干具体实现细节,但是这些不应当被解释为对本公开的范围的限制。在单独的实施例的上下文中描述的某些特征还可以组合地实现在单个实施例中。相反地,在单个实施例的上下文中描述的各种特征也可以单独地或以任何合适的子组合的方式实现在多个实施例中。
尽管已经采用特定于结构特征和/或方法逻辑动作的语言描述了本主题,但是应当理解所附权利要求书中所限定的主题未必局限于上面描述的特定特征或动作。相反,上面所描述的特定特征和动作仅仅是实现权利要求书的示例形式。

Claims (112)

  1. 一种信息交互的方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作;
    根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
    响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
  2. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二对象包括在接收到所述标签添加操作之后获得的所述第一对象的新关联对象。
  3. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二对象包括在接收到所述标签添加操作之前获得的所述第一对象的历史关联对象。
  4. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述生成第二对应关系包括:
    响应于确定所述用户触发开启标签自动添加功能,根据所述标签添加操作生成第二对应关系。
  5. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    根据所述标签添加操作,确定所述第二对应关系中所述目标标签的标签类型为自动添加类型。
  6. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    接收用户对所述第二对象触发的标签添加操作,所述第二对象触发的标签添加操作用于为所述第二对象添加所述目标标签;
    根据所述第二对象触发的标签添加操作将所述第二对应关系中所述目标标签的标签类型修改为手动添加类型。
  7. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,在根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系之前,所述方法还包括:
    根据所述标签添加操作确定所述目标标签。
  8. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述生成第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第一对象所指示的用户集合具有所述第二对象的访问权限, 生成所述第二对应关系。
  9. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,在生成所述第二对应关系之后,所述方法还包括:
    显示提示信息,所述提示信息用于提示用户所述第一对应关系和所述第二对应关系已被生成。
  10. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,在生成所述第二对应关系之后,所述方法还包括:
    在所述目标标签的标签展示界面展示所述第一对象和所述第二对象。
  11. 根据权利要求9所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    接收所述用户对所述标签展示界面的筛选控件触发的筛选操作,所述筛选操作用于从具有所述目标标签的对象中筛选出与所述第一对象相关联的对象;
    根据所述筛选操作展示所述第二对象。
  12. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述目标标签在预先设置的共享范围内,对所述共享范围内的用户具有可见性,其中,所述共享范围包括至少两个用户。
  13. 根据权利要求12所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:响应于所述第一对应关系的生成,向所述共享范围所包括的至少两个用户中的至少一个用户关联呈现所述目标标签和所述第一对象。
  14. 根据权利要求12所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:响应于所述第二对应关系的生成,向所述共享范围所包括的至少两个用户中的至少一个用户关联呈现所述目标标签和所述第二对象。
  15. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述第一对应关系被删除,或,所述第一对象和所述第二对象之间的关联关系被解除,删除所述第二对应关系。
  16. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于接收到所述用户对所述第二对象触发的标签删除操作,删除所述第二对应关系。
  17. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于接收到所述用户对所述第二对象触发的标签编辑操作,根据所 述标签编辑操作修改所述第二对应关系中的目标标签。
  18. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于接收到所述用户对所述第二对象触发的标签添加操作,生成第三对应关系,所述第三对应关系为所述第二对象和第一标签的对应关系,所述第一标签为标签添加操作所添加的标签。
  19. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组。
  20. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组。
  21. 一种信息交互的方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对即时通讯群组触发的标签添加操作;
    根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述即时通讯群组之间的对应关系;
    响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和与所述即时通讯群组相关联的对象之间的对应关系。
  22. 根据权利要求21所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与所述即时通讯群组相关联的对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    即时通讯Pin消息、云文件和本地文件。
  23. 根据权利要求22所述的方法,其特征在于,所述云文件包括云文档。
  24. 根据权利要求21所述的方法,其特征在于,所述生成第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述即时通讯群组具有所述即时通讯群组相关联的对象的访问权限,根据所述标签添加操作生成所述第二对应关系。
  25. 一种信息交互的方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对文件夹触发的标签添加操作;
    根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述文件夹之间的对应关系;
    响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和与所述文件夹相关联的对象之间的对应关系。
  26. 根据权利要求25所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与所述文件夹相关联的对象包括属于所述文件夹的文件和/或文件夹。
  27. 一种信息交互的方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对日程触发的标签添加操作;
    根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述日程的对应关系;
    响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和与所述日程相关联的对象之间的对应关系。
  28. 根据权利要求27所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与所述日程相关联的对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    云文件、本地文件、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组消息。
  29. 一种标签删除方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作;
    根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
    响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
  30. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二对应关系是基于用于生成所述第一对应关系的标签添加操作生成的。
  31. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作包括:
    接收所述用户对第一对象的目标标签触发的标签删除操作。
  32. 根据权利要求31所述的方法,其特征在于,所述接收用户对第一对象的目标标签触发的标签删除操作包括:
    接收所述用户对标签删除控件触发的标签删除操作,所述标签删除控 件用于删除所述第一对象的目标标签。
  33. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作包括:
    接收所述用户对所述第一对象触发的删除操作。
  34. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,在删除所述第二对应关系之前,所述方法还包括:
    根据所述第一对应关系确定所述第二对应关系。
  35. 根据权利要求34所述的方法,其特征在于,所述删除第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第二对应关系中目标标签的标签类型为自动添加类型,根据所述用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作删除所述第二对应关系。
  36. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于删除所述第一对应关系,且第三对应关系中目标标签的标签类型为手动添加类型,保留所述第三对应关系,所述第三对应关系为所述目标标签和第三对象之间的对应关系,所述第三对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
  37. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述删除第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第二对象与目标对象集合中除所述第一对象以外的至少一个对象相关联,且接收到对所述至少一个对象中每个对象触发的标签删除操作,删除所述第二对应关系,所述目标对象集合包括具有目标标签的至少一个对象。
  38. 根据权利要求37所述的方法,其特征在于,在删除所述第一对应关系之后,且在接收到对所述至少一个对象中每个对象触发的标签删除操作之前,所述方法还包括:
    在所述目标标签的标签展示界面中展示所述第二对象。
  39. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述根据所述用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作删除第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第二对象与目标对象集合中除所述第一对象以外的其他对象均不关联,根据所述标签删除操作删除所述第二对应关系,所述目标对 象集合包括具有目标标签的对象。
  40. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于解除所述第一对象和所述第二对象之间的关联关系删除所述第二对应关系。
  41. 根据权利要求40所述的方法,其特征在于,所述删除所述第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第二对象与目标对象集合中除所述第一对象以外的至少一个对象相关联,且接收到用户对所述至少一个对象中每个对象触发的标签删除操作,删除所述第二对应关系,所述目标对象集合包括具有目标标签的对象。
  42. 根据权利要求40所述的方法,其特征在于,所述删除所述第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第二对象与目标对象集合中除所述第一对象以外的至少一个对象相关联,且解除所述至少一个对象中每个对象和所述第二对象之间的关联关系,删除所述第二对应关系,所述目标对象集合包括具有目标标签的至少一个对象。
  43. 根据权利要求41或42所述的方法,其特征在于,在接收到用户对所述至少一个对象中每个对象触发的标签删除操作或全部解除所述至少一个对象中每个对象和所述第二对象之间的关联关系之前,所述方法还包括:
    在所述目标标签的标签展示界面展示所述第二对象。
  44. 根据权利要求40所述的方法,其特征在于,所述删除第二对应关系包括:
    响应于所述第二对象与目标对象集合中除所述第一对象以外的其他对象均不关联,删除所述第二对应关系,所述目标对象集合包括具有目标标签的对象。
  45. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组。
  46. 根据权利要求29所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    文件夹、云文件、本地文件、日程、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组。
  47. 一种标签删除方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对即时通讯群组触发的标签删除操作;
    根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述即时通讯群组之间的对应关系;
    响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和与所述即时通讯群组相关联的对象之间的对应关系。
  48. 根据权利要求47所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与所述即时通讯群组相关联的对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    即时通讯Pin消息、云文件和本地文件。
  49. 根据权利要求48所述的方法,其特征在于,所述云文件包括云文档。
  50. 一种标签删除方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对文件夹触发的标签删除操作;
    根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述文件夹之间的对应关系;
    响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和与所述文件夹相关联的对象之间的对应关系。
  51. 根据权利要求50所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与所述文件夹相关联的对象包括属于所述文件夹的文件和/或文件夹。
  52. 一种标签删除方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    接收用户对日程触发的标签删除操作;
    根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述日程的对应关系;
    响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和与所述日程相关联的对象之间的对应关系。
  53. 根据权利要求52所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与所述日程相关 联的对象至少包括以下其中一种:
    云文件、本地文件、任务、即时通讯消息和即时通讯群组消息。
  54. 一种信息交互的装置,其特征在于,包括:
    接收模块,用于接收用户对第一对象触发的标签添加操作;
    第一生成模块,用于根据所述标签添加操作生成第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
    第二生成模块,用于响应于生成所述第一对应关系,生成第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
  55. 一种标签删除装置,其特征在于,包括:
    接收模块,用于接收用户对第一对象触发的标签删除操作;
    第一删除模块,用于根据所述标签删除操作删除第一对应关系,所述第一对应关系为目标标签和所述第一对象之间的对应关系;
    第二删除模块,用于响应于删除所述第一对应关系,删除第二对应关系,所述第二对应关系为所述目标标签和第二对象之间的对应关系,所述第二对象为与所述第一对象相关联的对象。
  56. 一种基于任务的信息处理方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务,所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享;
    在第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,所述第一页面为:登录所述第一用户的账户的客户端上显示的页面。
  57. 根据权利要求56所述的方法,其特征在于,所述与第一用户相关的任务,包括以下任意一项或者多项:
    创建者为所述第一用户的任务、执行者为所述第一用户的任务、以及所述第一用户关注的任务。
  58. 根据权利要求56所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个任务包括第一任务,所述第一任务的信息,包括以下任意一项或者多项:
    所述第一任务所具备的标签、所述第一任务的创建者、所述第一任务的执行者、所述第一任务的截止日期、所述第一任务的状态以及所述第一任务的摘要信息。
  59. 根据权利要求56-58任意一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,以列表形式在所述第一页面中显示,一个任务的信息对应所述列表中的一条记录,所述列表的表头用于指示所述每个任务的信息所包括的内容。
  60. 根据权利要求59所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述第一用户针对所述表头触发的任务信息选择操作,确定所述第一页面上显示的所述每个任务的信息所包括的内容。
  61. 根据权利要求56-60任意一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个任务中的每个任务的信息的排列顺序为:所述至少一个任务中每个任务的截止日期由近到远的顺序。
  62. 根据权利要求56-61任意一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于第一用户针对所述至少一个任务中的第一任务触发的位置移动操作,修改所述第一任务在所述第一页面中的显示位置。
  63. 根据权利要求56-62任意一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述第一用户触发的任务筛选操作,获取至少一个维度的筛选条件;
    从所述至少一个任务中确定符合所述筛选条件的任务;
    显示筛选得到的所述任务的信息。
  64. 根据权利要求63所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个维度,包括:
    标签、创建者、执行者、截止日期、以及状态。
  65. 根据权利要求56所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个任务包括:具备第一标签的第一任务,所述方法还包括:
    响应于用户在所述第一标签的概览页面中触发的任务创建操作,创建所述第一任务,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息;或者,
    响应于用户在所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面中触发的任务创建操作,创建所述第一任务,所述任务信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的任务的信息。
  66. 根据权利要求56所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个任务包括:具备第一标签的第一任务,所述方法还包括:
    响应于用户在第一任务对应的页面中触发的标签添加操作,获取所述标签添加操作对应的所述第一标签;
    保存所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系。
  67. 根据权利要求65所述的方法,其特征在于,所述至少一个任务包括:具备第一标签的第一任务,所述方法还包括:
    响应于用户在所述第一标签的任务信息域对应的页面中触发的标签取消操作,删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系,删除所述第一任务和所述第一标签的关联关系之后,所述第一标签的概览页面和所述任务信息域对应的页面中,不包括所述第一任务。
  68. 一种信息处理方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域;
    响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应第二信息域的候选信息,所述第二信息域与所述第一信息域不同;
    响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
  69. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,所述响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,包括:
    响应于所述用户在第一标签的概览页面中触发的针对所述第一信息域的信息添加操作,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息。
  70. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,响应于针对所述第一信息域的信息添加操作所呈现的第一信息添加页面中,还默认呈现对应所述第一信息域的候选信息。
  71. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    在所述第一标签的、所述第二信息域对应的页面中,显示所述至少一个信息。
  72. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述用户在第一标签的概览页面中触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第二信息添加页面,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息;
    获取所述用户在所述第二信息添加页面中添加的与所述第一信息域对应的第一信息;
    生成所述第一信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
  73. 根据权利要求72所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    在所述概览页面中显示所述第一信息,以及,
    在所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面中显示所述第一信息。
  74. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述用户在所述概览页面中触发的协作者编辑操作,获取编辑后的协作者的信息,生成所述编辑后的协作者与所述第一标签的对应关系。
  75. 根据权利要求74所述的方法,其特征在于,所述协作者修改操作,包括:
    协作者增加操作,或者,协作者删除操作,或者,协作者修改操作;其中,所述协作者修改操作用于将第一协作者修改为第二协作者。
  76. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一标签的概览页面中显示有各信息域中,具有所述第一标签的信息数量,所述各个信息域包括所述第一信息域;所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述用户针对所述第一信息域对应的信息数量触发的预设操作,显示所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的页面,所述第一信息域对应的页面中包括具备所述第一标签的、所述第一信息域对应的信息的信息摘要。
  77. 根据权利要求68所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述用户针对第一标签的概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作,跳转至包括所述第二信息的页面;或者,
    响应于所述用户针对所述概览页面中的第二信息触发的预设操作,显示所述第二信息,其中,所述用户具备所述第二信息的查看权限;
    所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息。
  78. 根据权利要求77所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二信息为即时通信消息,所述方法还包括:
    呈现所述第二信息的上下文信息。
  79. 根据权利要求77所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述用户在包括所述第二信息的页面中触发的预设操作,显示所述概览页面。
  80. 根据权利要求77所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二信息为群组,所述显示所述第二信息,包括:
    在所述概览页面中的第一区域显示所述群组对应的即时会话界面。
  81. 根据权利要求80所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    接收所述用户在所述第一区域输入的即时会话消息,所述用户为所述群组中包括的用户;
    在所述即时会话界面中显示所述即时会话消息。
  82. 根据权利要求68-81任意一项所述的方法,其特征在于,
    所述第一信息域为以下任意一项:任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组;
    所述第二信息域为以下任意一项:任务、云文档、消息、日程、以及群组。
  83. 一种基于任务的信息处理装置,其特征在于,所述装置包括:
    第一获取单元,用于获取与第一用户相关、且具备标签的至少一个任务,所述标签为所述至少一个任务的附加属性,所述标签在由所述标签的权限所确定的预设范围内共享;
    第一显示单元,用于在第一页面上显示所述至少一个任务中每个任务分别对应的信息,所述第一页面为:登录所述第一用户的账户的客户端上显示的页面。
  84. 一种信息处理装置,其特征在于,所述装置包括:
    第一显示单元,用于响应于用户触发的针对第一信息域的信息添加操作,显示第一信息添加页面,所述第一信息添加页面中包括多个信息域的标识,所述多个信息域包括所述第一信息域和第二信息域;
    第二显示单元,用于响应于所述用户针对所述第二信息域的标识触发的选择操作,显示对应第二信息域的候选信息,所述第二信息域与所述第一信息域不同;
    第一生成单元,用于响应于所述用户针对所述候选信息中的至少一个信息触发的选择操作,生成所述至少一个信息和所述第一标签的关联关系。
  85. 一种日程创建方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
    获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,生成具备所述第一标签的日程。
  86. 根据权利要求85所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取标签编辑操作所指示的第二标签;
    所述生成具备所述第一标签的日程,包括:
    生成具备所述第一标签和所述第二标签的日程。
  87. 根据权利要求86所述的方法,其特征在于,所述用户通过标签添加控件触发所述标签编辑操作。
  88. 根据权利要求86或87所述的方法,其特征在于,响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取第二标签,包括:
    响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,所述至少一个标签候选项包括所述第二标签;
    响应于所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发的选择操作,获取所述第二标签。
  89. 根据权利要求86或87所述的方法,其特征在于,响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取第二标签,包括:
    响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取用户输入的字符,根据所述用户输入的字符获取所述第二标签。
  90. 根据权利要求86所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    在所述第二标签对应的日程页面中,显示所述日程的摘要信息,所述第二标签对应的日程页面,用于显示具备所述第二标签的日程的摘要信息。
  91. 根据权利要求85所述的方法,其特征在于,所述日程添加页面中还包括:所述日程的参与者,所述日程的参与者为具备所述第一标签的查看权限 的用户。
  92. 根据权利要求85所述的方法,其特征在于,所述获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,包括:
    获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的所述日程的参与者。
  93. 根据权利要求92所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    若在生成具备所述第一标签的日程之前,所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的所述日程的参与者,不具备所述第一标签的权限,则响应于具备所述第一标签的日程的生成,赋予所述日程的参与者所述第一标签的权限。
  94. 根据权利要求85所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一标签在具备所述第一标签的权限的用户间共享。
  95. 根据权利要求94所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一标签的权限,包括使用权限,具备所述第一标签的使用权限的用户,具备在其对应的客户端上为信息单元添加所述第一标签的权限。
  96. 根据权利要求94所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一标签的权限,包括查看权限,具备所述第一标签的查看权限的用户的客户端上,显示所述第一标签的关联信息。
  97. 根据权利要求96所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    响应于第一用户具备所述第一标签的查看权限,在所述第一用户的客户端上,关联呈现所述第一标签和第一信息单元,其中,所述第一信息单元为所述第一用户具备查看权限的信息单元。
  98. 根据权利要求85所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一标签的关联页面,包括:
    所述第一标签的概览页面,或者,所述第一标签的日程信息域对应的页面;其中:
    所述概览页面为对具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息进行汇总显示的页面;或者,所述日程信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的日程的信息。
  99. 根据权利要求98所述的方法,其特征在于,所述各个信息域对应的信息,在所述概览页面中分区域呈现。
  100. 一种日程创建方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
    响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签;
    获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息,生成具备所述第二标签的日程。
  101. 根据权利要求100所述的方法,其特征在于,响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签,包括:
    响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,显示至少一个标签候选项,所述至少一个标签候选项包括所述第二标签;
    响应于所述用户针对所述至少一个标签候选项中的所述第二标签触发的选择操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签。
  102. 根据权利要求101所述的方法,其特征在于,响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签,包括:
    响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,获取用户输入的字符,根据所述用户输入的字符获取所述第二标签,并将所述第一标签修改为第二标签。
  103. 根据权利要求100-102任意一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    在所述第二标签对应的日程页面中,显示所述日程的摘要信息,所述第二标签对应的日程页面,用于显示具备所述第二标签的日程的摘要信息。
  104. 一种日程创建装置,其特征在于,所述装置包括:
    显示单元,用于响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
    第一获取单元,用于获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息;
    生成单元,用于生成具备所述第一标签的日程。
  105. 一种日程创建装置,其特征在于,所述装置包括:
    第一显示单元,用于响应于用户在第一标签的关联页面中触发的日程添加操作,显示日程添加页面,所述日程添加页面中包括所述第一标签,所述第一标签的关联页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息;
    修改单元,用于响应于所述用户在所述日程添加页面中触发的标签编辑操作,将所述第一标签修改为第二标签;
    获取单元,用于获取所述用户在所述日程添加页面中输入的日程信息;
    生成单元,用于生成具备所述第二标签的日程。
  106. 一种信息处理方法,其特征在于,所述方法包括:
    响应于在第一标签的关联页面触发的对象添加操作,获取添加操作所确定的目标对象的信息;
    基于所述目标对象的信息,生成所述目标对象和所述第一标签的关联关系。
  107. 根据权利要求106所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一标签的关联页面,包括以下至少一项:
    具备所述第一标签的群组对应的群组会话页面,具备所述第一标签的文件夹对应的页面,具备所述第一标签的日程对应的页面,用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息的页面。
  108. 根据权利要求107所述的方法,其特征在于,所述用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息的页面,包括:
    所述第一标签的概览页面,所述第一标签的概览页面用于分区域显示具备所述第一标签的各个信息域的信息。
  109. 根据权利要求107所述的方法,其特征在于,所述用于呈现所述第一标签的关联信息的页面,包括:
    所述第一标签的日程信息域对应的页面,所述日程信息域对应的页面,用于显示具备所述第一标签的日程的信息。
  110. 一种设备,其特征在于,所述设备包括处理器和存储器;
    所述处理器用于执行所述存储器中存储的指令,以使得所述设备执行如权利要求1至53中任一项所述的方法,或者,以使得所述设备执行如权利要求56至82中任一项所述的方法,或者,以使得所述设备执行如权利要求85至103中任一项所述的方法,或者,以使得所述设备执行如权利要求106-109任 意一项所述的方法。
  111. 一种计算机可读存储介质,其特征在于,包括指令,所述指令指示设备执行如权利要求1至53中任一项所述的方法,或者,所述指令指示设备执行如权利要求56至82中任一项所述的方法,或者,所述指令指示设备执行如权利要求85至103中任一项所述的方法,或者,所述指令指示设备执行如权利要求106-109任意一项所述的方法。
  112. 一种计算机程序产品,其特征在于,当所述计算机程序产品在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行如权利要求1至53中任一项所述的方法,或者,使得计算机执行如权利要求56至82中任一项所述的方法,或者,使得计算机执行如权利要求85至103中任一项所述的方法,或者,使得计算机执行如权利要求106-109任意一项所述的方法。
PCT/CN2022/081127 2021-03-25 2022-03-16 信息交互/处理方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法及装置 WO2022199438A1 (zh)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US18/552,299 US20240195772A1 (en) 2021-03-25 2022-03-16 Information interaction/processing method, tag deletion method, and schedule creation method and device

Applications Claiming Priority (6)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CN202110322529.5 2021-03-25
CN202110321003.5 2021-03-25
CN202110322528.0A CN115129404B (zh) 2021-03-25 2021-03-25 一种基于任务的信息处理方法及装置
CN202110322528.0 2021-03-25
CN202110321003.5A CN115130975A (zh) 2021-03-25 2021-03-25 一种日程创建方法及装置
CN202110322529.5A CN115129405A (zh) 2021-03-25 2021-03-25 一种信息交互的方法、标签删除方法及装置

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2022199438A1 true WO2022199438A1 (zh) 2022-09-29

Family

ID=83395137

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/CN2022/081127 WO2022199438A1 (zh) 2021-03-25 2022-03-16 信息交互/处理方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法及装置

Country Status (2)

Country Link
US (1) US20240195772A1 (zh)
WO (1) WO2022199438A1 (zh)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN115130975A (zh) * 2021-03-25 2022-09-30 北京字跳网络技术有限公司 一种日程创建方法及装置

Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN102654911A (zh) * 2011-03-04 2012-09-05 北京网秦天下科技有限公司 日程管理方法和系统
CN102857605A (zh) * 2012-07-23 2013-01-02 北京小米科技有限责任公司 一种联系人分组方法及装置
WO2015200681A1 (en) * 2014-06-25 2015-12-30 James Noland Method, system, and medium for workflow management of document processing
CN106600223A (zh) * 2016-12-09 2017-04-26 奇酷互联网络科技(深圳)有限公司 一种日程创建的方法及装置
CN109040329A (zh) * 2018-06-11 2018-12-18 平安科技(深圳)有限公司 联系人标签的确定方法、终端设备及介质
CN112307397A (zh) * 2020-10-29 2021-02-02 腾讯科技(深圳)有限公司 基于在线文档的日程处理方法、装置、设备及存储介质

Patent Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN102654911A (zh) * 2011-03-04 2012-09-05 北京网秦天下科技有限公司 日程管理方法和系统
CN102857605A (zh) * 2012-07-23 2013-01-02 北京小米科技有限责任公司 一种联系人分组方法及装置
WO2015200681A1 (en) * 2014-06-25 2015-12-30 James Noland Method, system, and medium for workflow management of document processing
CN106600223A (zh) * 2016-12-09 2017-04-26 奇酷互联网络科技(深圳)有限公司 一种日程创建的方法及装置
CN109040329A (zh) * 2018-06-11 2018-12-18 平安科技(深圳)有限公司 联系人标签的确定方法、终端设备及介质
CN112307397A (zh) * 2020-10-29 2021-02-02 腾讯科技(深圳)有限公司 基于在线文档的日程处理方法、装置、设备及存储介质

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN115130975A (zh) * 2021-03-25 2022-09-30 北京字跳网络技术有限公司 一种日程创建方法及装置

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20240195772A1 (en) 2024-06-13

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
CN112583700B (zh) 群组创建方法、装置、设备及存储介质
CN111512328B (zh) 协作文档访问记录和管理
US10671245B2 (en) Collection and control of user activity set data and activity set user interface
US20170168692A1 (en) Dual-Modality Client Application
CN102640139B (zh) 协作浏览与相关方法和系统
US10243899B2 (en) Content-item relationship messaging system
US20240061959A1 (en) Information processing, information interaction, tag viewing and information display method and apparatus
WO2023016536A1 (zh) 一种交互方法、装置、设备和存储介质
US20230394440A1 (en) Generating collaborative documents for virtual meetings in a communication platform
WO2022199438A1 (zh) 信息交互/处理方法、标签删除方法、日程创建方法及装置
CN115733812A (zh) 一种信息交互方法、装置、设备及介质
CN115134104B (zh) 信息处理方法、信息显示方法及装置
CN115061601A (zh) 电子文档的处理方法、装置、终端和存储介质
WO2023220303A1 (en) Contextual workflow buttons
CN116301462A (zh) 信息处理方法、装置、电子设备和存储介质
CN114967992A (zh) 一种信息交互的方法、标签查看方法及装置
US11888631B2 (en) Document management in a communication platform
CN116016420A (zh) 一种任务清单分享方法、装置、设备及介质
Finke et al. (De) Coding Social Practice in the Field of XAI: Towards a Co-constructive Framework of Explanations and Understanding Between Lay Users and Algorithmic Systems
CN114969302A (zh) 一种标签搜索方法及装置
US20230376515A1 (en) Generating summary documents for communications in a communication platform
CN115129405A (zh) 一种信息交互的方法、标签删除方法及装置
US11902228B1 (en) Interactive user status
US11848904B2 (en) Sharing custom history in multi-party direct message
US12099770B1 (en) Displaying predicted tasks based on changing devices

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 22774099

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 22774099

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1